Table of Contents

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON D.C. 20549
FORM 10-K
x      ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
 
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011
OR
o      TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
 
For the transition period from              to              .
Commission file number 1-33332
WABCO Holdings Inc.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
 
Delaware
 
20-8481962
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
 
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
Chaussee de Wavre, 1789
1160 Brussels, Belgium
 
 
 
 
One Centennial Avenue,
P.O. Box 6820, Piscataway, NJ
 
08855-6820
(Address of principal executive offices)
 
(Zip Code)
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code +32 2 663 98 00
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
    
Title of each class
 
Name of each exchange on which registered
Common stock, par value $0.01 per share
 
New York Stock Exchange
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
    
Title of each class
 
 
None
 
 
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.                             x   Yes                      o  No
    
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.         o   Yes                      x No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.     x   Yes     o   No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this


Table of Contents

chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).     x   Yes     o   No
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (Section 229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act (Check one).  
Large Accelerated Filer
 
x
  
Accelerated Filer
 
o
 
 
 
 
Non-Accelerated Filer
 
o
  
Smaller Reporting Company
 
o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).     o   Yes     x   No
The aggregate market value of the voting stock (Common Stock) held by non-affiliates of the registrant as of the close of business on June 30, 2011 was approximately $5.1 billion based on the closing sale price of the common stock on the New York Stock Exchange on that date. The registrant does not have any non-voting common equity.
Indicate the number of shares outstanding of each of the issuer’s classes of common stock, as of the latest practicable date.  
Common stock, $.01 par value, outstanding at
 
 
February 8, 2012
 
64,536,978 shares

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
Part III incorporates information from certain portions of the registrant's definitive proxy statement to be filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission within 120 days after the fiscal year end of December 31, 2011.



Table of Contents

WABCO HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
FORM 10-K
Year ended December 31, 2011
TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
 
Page
Item 1.
Item 1A.
Item 1B.
Item 2.
Item 3.
Item 4.
Item 4A.
Item 5.
Item 6.
Item 7.
Item 7A.
Item 8.
Item 9.
Item 9A.
Item 9B.
Item 10.
Item 11.
Item 12.
Item 13.
Item 14.
Item 15.
 

2

Table of Contents

Information Concerning Forward Looking Statements

Certain of the statements contained in this report (other than the historical financial data and other statements of historical fact), including, without limitation, statements as to management's expectations and beliefs, are forward-looking statements. These forward-looking statements were based on various facts and were derived utilizing numerous important assumptions and other important factors, and changes in such facts, assumptions or factors could cause actual results to differ materially from those in the forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements include the information concerning our future financial performance, financial condition, liquidity, business strategy, projected plans and objectives. Statements preceded by, followed by or that otherwise include the words “believes,” “expects,” “anticipates,” “strategies,” “prospects,” “intends,” “projects,” “estimates,” “plans,” “may increase,” “may fluctuate,” and similar expression or future or conditional verbs such as “will,” “should,” “would,” “may” and “could” are generally forward looking in nature and not historical facts. This report includes important information as to risk factors in “Item 1. Business”, “Item 1A. Risk Factors”, and “Item 7. Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.” Many important factors could cause actual results to differ materially from management's expectations, including: 

the actual level of commercial vehicle production in our end-markets;
adverse developments in the business of our key customers;
periodic changes to contingent liabilities, including those associated with litigation matters and government investigations;
adverse developments in general business, economic and political conditions or any outbreak or escalation of hostilities on a national, regional or international basis;
changes in international or U.S. economic conditions, such as inflation, interest rate fluctuations, foreign exchange rate fluctuations or recessions in our markets;
unpredictable difficulties or delays in the development of new product technology;
pricing changes to our supplies or products or those of our competitors, and other competitive pressures on pricing and sales;
our ability to receive component parts from our suppliers;
our ability to access credit markets or capital markets on a favorable basis or at all;
changes in the environmental regulations that affect our current and future products;
competition in our existing and future lines of business and the financial resources of competitors;
our failure to comply with regulations and any changes in regulations;
our failure to complete potential future acquisitions or to realize benefits from completed acquisitions;
our inability to implement our growth plan;
the loss of any of our senior management;
difficulties in obtaining or retaining the management and other human resource competencies that we need to achieve our business objectives;
labor relations; and
risks inherent in operating in foreign countries, including exposure to local economic conditions, government regulation, currency restrictions and other restraints, changes in tax laws, expropriation, political instability and diminished ability to legally enforce our contractual rights.
 
We undertake no obligation to release publicly any revisions to any forward-looking statements, to report events or to report the occurrence of unanticipated events unless we are required to do so by law .





3

Table of Contents

ITEM 1.      BUSINESS
Overview
Except as otherwise indicated or unless context otherwise requires “WABCO”, “WABCO Holdings Inc.,” “we,” “us,” “our,” and “the Company” refer to WABCO Holdings Inc. and its consolidated subsidiaries.
WABCO is a leading provider of electronic, mechanical and mechatronic products for the world's leading commercial truck, trailer, bus and passenger car manufacturers. We manufacture and sell control systems, including advanced braking, stability, suspension, transmission control and air compressing and processing systems, that improve vehicle performance and safety and reduce overall vehicle operating costs. We estimate that our products are included in approximately two out of three commercial vehicles with advanced vehicle control systems and offered in sophisticated, niche applications in cars and sport utility vehicles (SUVs). We continue to grow in more parts of the world as we provide more components and systems throughout the life of a vehicle, from design and development to the aftermarket.

History of Our Company

WABCO was founded in the United States in 1869 as Westinghouse Air Brake Company. We were purchased by American Standard Companies Inc. (or “American Standard”) in 1968 and operated as the Vehicle Control Systems business division within American Standard until we were spun off from American Standard on July 31, 2007. Subsequent to our spin-off, American Standard changed its name to Trane Inc., which we herein refer to as “Trane.” On June 5, 2008, Trane was acquired in a merger with Ingersoll-Rand Company Limited (“Ingersoll Rand”) and exists today as a wholly owned subsidiary of Ingersoll-Rand.

The Separation of WABCO from Trane

The spin-off by Trane of its Vehicle Control Systems business became effective on July 31, 2007, through a distribution of 100% of the common stock of WABCO to Trane's shareholders (the “Distribution”). The Distribution was effected through a separation and distribution agreement pursuant to which Trane distributed all of the shares of WABCO common stock as a dividend on Trane common stock, in the amount of one share of WABCO common stock for every three shares of outstanding Trane common stock to each shareholder on the record date. Trane received a private letter ruling from the Internal Revenue Service and an opinion from tax counsel indicating that the spin-off was tax free to the shareholders of Trane and WABCO. Please refer to Item 1A. “Risk Factors” below for information on the tax risks associated with the spin-off from Trane.

Products and Services
We develop, manufacture and sell advanced braking, stability, suspension and transmission control systems primarily for commercial vehicles. Our largest-selling products are pneumatic anti-lock braking systems (ABS), electronic braking systems (EBS), automated manual transmission systems, air disk brakes, and a large variety of conventional mechanical products such as actuators, air compressors and air control valves for heavy- and medium-sized trucks, trailers and buses. We also supply advanced electronic suspension controls and vacuum pumps to the car and SUV markets in Europe, North America and Asia. We sell replacement parts, diagnostic tools, training and other services to commercial vehicle aftermarket distributors, repair shops, and fleet operators and provide remanufacturing services.
WABCO is a leader in improving highway safety, with products that help drivers prevent accidents by enhancing vehicle responsiveness and stability. For example, we offer a stability control system for trucks and buses that constantly monitors the vehicle's motion and dynamic stability. If the system detects vehicle instability, such as the driver swerving to avoid another vehicle, it responds by applying the brakes at specific wheels, or slowing the vehicle down to minimize the risk of instability or a rollover. In 2011, we signed contracts with major European commercial vehicle manufacturers to deliver our new breakthrough c-comp™ clutchable air compressor technology. The c-comp™ technology optimally disengages a truck or bus air compressor from the engine when the vehicle’s air system reaches full pressure, allowing for fuel savings up to 264 gallons (1,000 liters) on long haul applications while reducing the vehicle’s carbon dioxide emissions. In 2010, we presented our breakthrough OnGuardPLUS™ technology, an advanced emergency braking system (AEBS). OnGuardPLUS is the commercial vehicle industry's first system in compliance with the European Union's expected regulation to make AEBS mandatory on new heavy commercial vehicles beginning in November 2013. Using a single radar sensor and proprietary algorithms, OnGuardPLUS systems will be available beginning in 2012 for trucks and buses worldwide.

Our key product groups and functions are described below.
 

4

Table of Contents

WABCO KEY PRODUCT GROUPS
SYSTEM / PRODUCT
 
FUNCTION
Actuator
 
Converts Energy Stored in Compressed Air into Mechanical Force Applied to Foundation Brake to Slow or Stop Commercial Vehicles
Air Compressor and Air Processing/Air Management System
 
Provides Compressed, Dried Air for Braking, Suspension and other Pneumatic Systems on Trucks, Buses and Trailers
Foundation Brake
 
Transmits Braking Force to a Disc or Drum (Connected to the Wheel) to Slow, Stop or Hold Vehicles
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS)
 
Prevents Wheel Locking during Braking to Ensure Steerability and Stability
Conventional Braking System
 
Mechanical and Pneumatic Devices for Control of Braking Systems in Commercial Vehicles
Electronic Braking System (EBS)
 
Electronic Controls of Braking Systems for Commercial Vehicles
Electronic and Conventional Air Suspension Systems
 
Level Control of Air Springs in Trucks, Buses, Trailers and Cars
Transmission Automation
 
Automates Transmission Gear Shifting for Trucks and Buses
Vehicle Electronic Architecture (VEA)
 
Central Electronic Modules Integrating Multiple Vehicle Control Functions
Vehicle Electronic Stability Control (ESC) and Roll Stability Support (RSS)
 
Enhances Driving Stability

Key Markets and Trends
Electronically controlled products and systems are important for the growth of our business. The market for these products is driven primarily by the growing electronics content of control systems in commercial vehicles. The electronics content has been increasing steadily with each successive platform introduction, as original equipment manufacturers (OEMs) look to improve safety and performance through added functionalities, and meet evolving regulatory safety standards. Overall the trends in commercial vehicle design show a shift in demand towards electronics content. Although the pace varies, this is a trend in all major geographies, and braking systems are part of this broader shift from conventional to advanced electronic systems. In addition to increasing safety, improving stopping distances, and reducing installation complexity, advanced EBS also allow for new functionality to be introduced into vehicles at a lower price. The new functionality includes stability control, adaptive cruise control, automated transmission controls, brake performance warning, vehicle diagnostics, driver assistance systems and engine braking/speed control. Adaptive cruise control uses sensors to detect proximity to other vehicles and automatically adjusts speed. Automated transmission controls reduce the amount of gear shifting, resulting in less physical effort and training required for drivers, less component wear, fewer parts, better fuel efficiency, and enhanced driver safety and comfort.
Another key market in the global commercial vehicle industry is the trend toward environmental sustainability. This means improving fuel efficiency and reducing emissions. WABCO continues to innovate technology that increases fuel efficiency, reduces vehicle weight and optimizes energy recovery, among other advancements that increase the environmental friendliness of trucks, buses and trailers over the lifetime of the vehicle. WABCO increases fuel efficiency through industry breakthroughs such as clutch compressors, high-output two-stage compressors and advanced transmission automation systems. WABCO reduces vehicle weight, which influences fuels savings, through industry-leading engineering involving lighter materials and optimized weight-to-performance ratios in a new generation of technologies such as air disc brakes, high-output compressors and air dryer systems. WABCO recuperates energy through industry-leading innovations in air processing technology, electrically driven compressors and other products that integrate the vehicle's mechanical operations and braking.
A fundamental driver of demand for our products is commercial truck production. Commercial truck production generally follows a multi-year cyclical pattern. While the number of new commercial vehicles built fluctuates each year, we have over the last five years demonstrated the ability to grow in excess of these fluctuations by increasing the amount of content on each vehicle. During the five year period through 2011, WABCO's European sales to T&B OEM customers, excluding the impact of foreign currency exchange rates, outperformed the rate of European T&B production by an average of 3% per year.


5

Table of Contents

Year to Year Change
    
2007
 
2008
 
2009
 
2010
 
2011
Sales to European T&B OEMs (at a constant FX rate)
    
12
%
 
4
%
 
(58
)%
 
60
%
 
34
%
European T&B Production
    
10
%
 
4
%
 
(62
)%
 
52
%
 
31
%

Customers
We sell our products primarily to four groups of customers around the world: truck and bus (OEMs), trailer (OEMs), commercial vehicle aftermarket distributors for replacement parts and services, and major car manufacturers. Our largest customer is Daimler, which accounted for approximately 12% and 13% of our sales in 2011 and 2010, respectively. Volvo accounted for 11% and 10% of our sales in 2011 and 2010, respectively. Other key customers include Ashok Leyland, BMW, China National Heavy Truck Corporation (CNHTC), Cummins, Fiat (Iveco), Hino, Hyundai, Krone, MAN Nutzfahrzeuge AG (MAN), Meritor, Meritor WABCO (a joint venture), Paccar (DAF Trucks N.V. (DAF), Kenworth, Leyland and Peterbilt), First Automobile Works, Otto Sauer Achsenfabrik (SAF), Scania, Schmitz Cargobull AG, TATA Motors and ZF Friedrichshafen AG (ZF). For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, our top 10 customers accounted for approximately 52% and 51% of our sales, respectively.
The largest group of our customers, representing approximately 64% of sales (63% in 2010), consists of truck and bus OEMs who are large, increasingly global and few in numbers due to industry consolidation. As truck and bus OEMs grow globally, they expect suppliers to grow with them beyond their traditional markets and become reliable partners, especially in the development of new technologies. WABCO has a strong reputation for technological innovation and often collaborates closely with major OEM customers to design and develop the technologies used in their products. Our products play an important role in vehicle safety and there are few other suppliers who compete across the breadth of products that we supply.
The second largest group, representing approximately 23% of sales (26% in 2010), consists of the commercial vehicle aftermarket distributor network that provides replacement parts to commercial vehicle operators. This distributor network is a fragmented and diverse group of customers, covering a broad spectrum from large OE-affiliated or owned distributors to small independent local distributors. The increasing number of commercial trucks in operation world-wide that are equipped with our products continuously increases demand for replacement parts and services, thus generating a growing stream of recurring aftermarket sales. Additionally, we continue to develop an array of service offerings such as diagnostics, training and other services to repair shops and fleet operators that will further enhance our presence and growth in the commercial vehicle aftermarket.
The next largest group, representing approximately 9% of sales (7% in 2010), consists of trailer manufacturers. Trailer manufacturers are also a fragmented group of local or regional players with great diversity in business size, focus and operation. Smaller trailer manufacturers are highly dependent on suppliers such as WABCO to provide technical expertise and product knowledge. Similar to truck and bus OEMs, trailer manufacturers rely heavily on our products for important safety functions and superior technology.
The smallest group, representing approximately 4% of sales (4% in 2010), consists of car and SUV manufacturers to whom WABCO sells electronic air suspension systems and vacuum pumps. Electronic air suspension is a luxury feature with increasing penetration and above market growth. Vacuum pumps are used with diesel and gasoline direct injection (“GDI”) engines and, therefore, enjoy higher than average growth rates associated with increasing diesel and GDI applications in Europe, Asia and North America. These customers are typically large, global and sophisticated customers who demand high product quality and overall service levels.
We address our customers through a global sales force that is organized around key accounts and customer groups and interfaces with product marketing and management to identify opportunities and meet customer needs across our product portfolio.
Europe represented approximately 62% of our sales in 2011, up from 60% in 2010, the remainder coming primarily from the Americas and Asia. Our products are also manufactured in Europe, Asia and the Americas. The growth in Asia is being enhanced by our strong roots in China and India where we have achieved leading positions in the marketplace through increasingly close connectivity to customers. We are further strengthened in Asia by an outstanding network of suppliers, manufacturing sites and engineering hubs.



6

Table of Contents

WABCO SALES
By Geography
FY 2011 % of Sales
By Major End-Market
FY 2011 % of Sales
     Europe
62
%
     Truck & Bus Products (OEMs)
64
%
     Asia
19
%
     Aftermarket
23
%
     North America
9
%
     Trailer Products
9
%
     South America
7
%
     Car Products
4
%
     Other
3
%
 
 

Backlog
Information on our backlog is set forth under Item 7. “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Backlog” of this annual report.
Cyclical and Seasonal Nature of Business
Information on the cyclical and seasonal nature of our business is set forth under Item 7 “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Cyclical and Seasonal Nature of Business” of this annual report.

Growth Strategy
Our growth strategy is focused on four key platforms: technology innovation, geographic expansion, aftermarket growth and opportunistic automotive application of our products and systems. Drivers of growth for both our aftermarket and advanced car systems are discussed in “Customers” above.
Technology
WABCO is focused on global technology trends that are relevant to our customers. Our technology strategy has two pillars to create value for manufacturers of commercial vehicles in every region of the world. One technology pillar is advanced safety and driver effectiveness to reduce the number of accidents involving commercial vehicles. Another technology pillar is vehicle efficiency to improve the environmental sustainability of trucks, buses and trailers.
We continue to drive growth by utilizing our industry-leading expertise in developing electronically controlled systems, including braking, transmission automation, air suspension and air management systems. We have a strong track record of innovation and are responsible for some of the industry's most important innovations including:
First heavy-duty truck anti-lock braking system (ABS);
First electronically controlled air suspension (ECAS) system for commercial vehicles;
First commercial vehicle automated manual transmission (AMT) controls system;
First electronic stability control (ESC) system for commercial vehicles;
First collision safety system with active braking developed for the North American market, based on Adaptive Cruise Control technology (ACC); and
First autonomous emergency braking (AEB) system for commercial vehicles, for collision imminent situations with moving or stopped vehicles.
 
We continue to expand our product and technology portfolio by introducing new products and functionalities, and by improving the penetration of recently launched technologies. Advanced products and functionalities are typically developed and adopted first in Europe and then migrate to North America and Asia. Important examples include the adoption of ABS and automated transmission systems that were first widely adopted in European markets before starting to penetrate North America and Asia. WABCO expended approximately $105.1 million in 2011, $85.9 million in 2010 and $75.2 million in 2009 for product engineering costs which include research activities and product development costs.
We are also focused on longer-term opportunities, particularly in the area of Advanced Driver Assistance Systems (ADAS). ADAS is a technology concept that involves connecting advanced sensors with truck control devices, such as braking and steering systems as well as engine controls, to improve safety and avoid collisions. In 2011, we signed contracts with major European commercial vehicle manufacturers to deliver our new breakthrough c-comp™ clutchable air compressor technology.

7

Table of Contents

The c-comp™ technology optimally disengages a truck or bus air compressor from the engine when the vehicle’s air system reaches full pressure, allowing for fuel savings up to 264 gallons (1,000 liters) on long haul applications while reducing the vehicle’s carbon dioxide emissions. In 2010, we presented our breakthrough OnGuardPLUS™ technology, an advanced emergency braking system (AEBS). OnGuardPLUS is the commercial vehicle industry's first system in compliance with the European Union's expected regulation to make AEBS mandatory on new heavy commercial vehicles beginning in November 2013. Using a single radar sensor and proprietary algorithms, OnGuardPLUS systems will be available beginning in 2012 for trucks and buses worldwide.
Geographic Expansion
We continue to drive sales in the high growth markets of Eastern Europe, China, India and Brazil. In Eastern Europe, we have been manufacturing products since 2001. The market in Eastern Europe has historically experienced rapid growth, and we have established relationships with local customers.
Brazil
Brazil is a long-term growth market for WABCO due to its expected volume of truck and bus production and increasing adoption of advanced technology from commercial vehicles. For example, the Brazilian federal government has mandated that anti-lock braking systems will be compulsory on new trucks, buses and trailers in a phased approach starting in 2013 to further increase road safety. Also in 2010, WABCO celebrated its 30th anniversary in Brazil where the company is well anchored and has substantially advanced its local capabilities to integrate WABCO's technologies, product engineering and lean manufacturing within our global organization. WABCO's potential for growth in South America is due to our ability in Brazil to leverage global engineering, supply chain and support capabilities while deepening our connectivity with customers in the region. WABCO respects the specific needs of customers in South America through specially developed and locally adapted systems and products for emerging markets.
China
China is a key long-term growth market for us. The adoption of more advanced braking, safety and other related systems is increasing in China, and the number of trucks built in the country is expected to continue to increase in the longer term. We are the leading provider of advanced systems like ABS, with a strong brand and established customer relationships. We were honored with seven top supplier awards by seven leading Chinese manufacturers of commercial vehicles, a record achievement, in recognition of our superior performance in 2011. In the short-to medium-term, growth will be driven by the enforcement of existing regulations making ABS mandatory on trucks, buses and trailers, and we are well positioned to take advantage of this growth. Additional near term growth will be driven by introducing other new products into the local market such as our advanced air compressors and our new generation air disc brakes, clutch servos and automated manual transmission (AMT) systems. In 2011, we entered into a long term agreement with Shaanxi Fast Gear Company, Ltd., China's largest manufacturer of heavy duty transmissions, to develop and supply WABCO's OptiDrive TM system, further illustrating our ability to grow in this market. To serve the growing demand for products both in China and for export, we have four facilities to manufacture conventional products, advanced systems such as ABS, and new modular air compressors. The latest factory was built to more closely support the partnership with CNHTC, our largest customer in China. In addition, we built a facility in the Southern part of China to produce air disc brakes as part of the joint venture formed in December 2008 with Guangdong FUWA Heavy Industry Co., Ltd. (FUWA).
India

India is another growth market for us due to its expected volume of truck production and increasing adoption of advanced technology from commercial vehicles. We participate in this market through WABCO India, which we took a majority ownership position of during the second quarter of 2009, further strengthening the Company's already well-anchored position in India. With three world class factories in different areas of India, we are the market leader in compressed air related products and systems. We leverage this enviable position to introduce increasingly advanced technologies like ABS advanced braking or Optidrive automated manual transmission control systems. India also provides a strong base for sourcing and engineering activities, which we are actively developing. WABCO India is a sourcing hub for our global operations by purchasing raw materials locally at best cost and it provides machining capabilities in our factory in Mahindra City to process the metals, castings and electrical motors that are used in our other factories in Europe, North America, Brazil and China to manufacture our products.  WABCO India is also a center of mechanical and software engineering activity that provides a source of high skills at very competitive cost to develop software and mechanical systems to support WABCO globally. In particular, WABCO India has the expertise to develop products that completely satisfy emerging markets expectations and specificity.

Competition

8

Table of Contents

Given the importance of technological leadership, vehicle life-cycle expertise, reputation for quality and reliability, and the growing joint collaboration between OEMs and suppliers to drive new product development, the space in which we mostly operate has not historically had a large number of competitors. Our principal competitors are Knorr-Bremse (Knorr's U.S. subsidiary is Bendix Commercial Vehicle Systems) and, in certain categories, Haldex. In the advanced electronics categories, automotive players such as Bosch (automotive) and Continental (including Siemens-VDO) have recently been present in some commercial vehicle applications. In the mechanical product categories, several Asian competitors are emerging, primarily in China, who are focused on such products. In each of our product categories, we compete on the basis of price, manufacturing and distribution capabilities, product quality, product design, delivery and service.

Manufacturing and Operations
Most of our manufacturing sites and distribution centers produce and/or house a broad range of products and serve all different types of customers. Currently, over 68% of our manufacturing workforce is located in best cost countries such as China, India, Brazil and Poland up from approximately 10% in 1999. Facilities in best cost countries have historically helped reduce costs on the simpler and more labor-intensive products, while the facilities in Western Europe are focused on producing more technologically advanced products. However, the increasing need for more advanced products and systems in emerging markets leads us to expand local supply chain capabilities to progressively cover more complex manufacturing. All facilities globally are deploying Six Sigma Lean initiatives to improve service level and generate productivity. By applying the Six Sigma philosophy and tools we seek to improve quality and predictability of our processes. Lean is geared towards eliminating waste in our supply chain, manufacturing and administrative processes. Both methodologies are customer driven and data based. In addition, our global supply chain team makes decisions on where to manufacture which products taking into account such factors as local and export demand, customer approvals, cost, key supplier locations and factory capabilities.

Our global sourcing organization purchases a wide variety of components including electrical, electro-mechanical, cast aluminum products and steel, as well as copper, rubber and plastic containing components that represent a substantial portion of manufacturing costs. We source products on a global basis from three key regions: Western Europe, Central and Eastern Europe and Asia. To support the continuing shift of manufacturing to best cost countries, we also continue to shift more of our sourcing to best cost regions. Under the leadership of the global sourcing organization, which is organized around commodity and product groups, we identify and develop key suppliers and seek to integrate them as partners into our extended enterprise. Many of our Western European suppliers are accompanying us on our move to best cost countries. Since 1999, the share of our sourcing from best cost regions has increased from 10% to approximately 41%.
We have developed a strong position in the design, development, engineering and testing of products, components and systems. We are generally regarded in the industry as a systems expert, having in-depth technical knowledge and capabilities to support the development of advanced technology applications. Key customers depend on us and will typically involve us very early in the development process as they begin designing next generation platforms. We have approximately 1,557 employees dedicated to developing new products, components and systems as well as supporting and enhancing current applications and manufacturing processes. Our sales organization hosts application engineers that are based near customers in all regions around the world and are partially resident at some customer locations. We also have significant resources in best cost countries performing functions such as drawings, testing and software component development. We operate test tracks in Germany, Finland (for extreme weather test conditions) and India.

Joint Ventures
We use joint ventures globally to expand and enhance our access to customers. Our important joint ventures are:
A majority-owned joint venture (90%) in Japan with Sanwa-Seiki that distributes WABCO's products in the local market.
A majority-owned (70%) partnership in the U.S. with Cummins Engine Co. (WABCO Compressor Manufacturing Co.), a manufacturing partnership formed to produce air compressors designed by WABCO.
A majority-owned joint venture (70%) in China with Mingshui Automotive Fitting Factory (MAFF) that provides conventional mechanical products to the local market.
A majority-owned joint venture (70%) with Guangdong FUWA Heavy Industry Co., Ltd., (“FUWA”) to produce air disc brakes for commercial trailers in China. FUWA is the largest manufacturer of commercial trailer axles in China and in the world.
A 50% owned joint venture in Germany with Wurth Group (WABCOWURTH Workshop Services GmbH) that supplies commercial vehicle workshops, fleet owners and operators and end users internationally with multi-brand technology diagnostic systems.

9

Table of Contents

A 50% owned joint venture in North America with Arvin Meritor Automotive Inc. (Meritor WABCO) that markets ABS and other vehicle control products.
A minority equity investment in a joint venture in South Africa, where we have a 49% ownership joint venture with Sturrock & Robson Ltd (WABCO SA), a distributor of braking systems products.
 

Employees
We have 10,902 employees world-wide. Approximately 47% of our employees are salaried and 53% are hourly. Approximately 55% of our workforce is in Europe, 38% is in Asia, and the remaining 7% is in the Americas. Approximately 1,557 employees work in engineering/product development.
Employees located in our sites in Europe, Asia and South America are subject to collective bargaining, with internal company agreements or external agreements or laws at the region or country level. Currently 50% of our workforce is covered by collective bargaining agreements and most of those agreements expire during 2012. The employees' right to strike is typically protected by law and union membership is confidential information which does not have to be provided to the employer. The collective bargaining agreements are typically renegotiated on an annual basis. Our U.S. facilities are non-union. We have maintained good relationships with our employees around the world and historically have experienced very few work stoppages.

Intellectual Property
Patents and other proprietary rights are important to our business. We also rely upon trade secrets, manufacturing know-how, continuing technological innovations, and licensing opportunities to maintain and improve our competitive position. We review third-party proprietary rights, including patents and patent applications, as available, in an effort to develop an effective intellectual property strategy, avoid infringement of third-party proprietary rights, identify licensing opportunities, and monitor the intellectual property claims of others.
We own a large portfolio of patents that principally relate to our products and technologies, and we have, from time to time, licensed some of our patents. Patents for individual products and processes extend for varying periods according to the date of patent filing or grant and the legal term of patents in various countries where patent protection is obtained.
The WABCO brand is also protected by trademark registrations throughout the world in the key markets in which our products are sold.

While we consider our patents and trademarks to be valuable assets, we do not believe that our competitive position is materially dependent upon any single patent or group of related patents. At the same time, we recognize that technical leadership is an ongoing pillar of success and our intellectual property portfolio will continue to grow in importance for the company as a whole as a result. The risks associated with successful patent prosecution and defense, trademark protection and the exploitation and protection of other intellectual property rights accordingly is something that we are increasingly concerned with.

Environmental Regulation
Our operations are subject to local, state, federal and foreign environmental laws and regulations that govern activities or operations that may have adverse environmental effects and which impose liability for clean-up costs resulting from past spills, disposals or other releases of hazardous wastes and environmental compliance. Generally, the international requirements that impact the majority of our operations tend to be no more restrictive than those in effect in the U.S.
Throughout the world, we have been dedicated to being an environmentally responsible manufacturer, neighbor and employer. We have a number of proactive programs under way to minimize our impact on the environment and believe that we are in substantial compliance with environmental laws and regulations. Manufacturing facilities are audited on a regular basis. Fourteen of our manufacturing facilities have Environmental Management Systems (EMS), which have been certified as ISO 14001 compliant. These facilities are those located in:
 
Claye-Souilly, France
Campinas, Brazil
Wroclaw, Poland
Gronau, Germany
Hanover, Germany
Jinan, China
Ambattur, India
Pyungtaek, Korea
Qingdao, China
Meppel, Netherlands
Mannheim, Germany
Charleston, United States
Mahindra World City, India
Rochester Hills, United States
 

10

Table of Contents

A number of our facilities are undertaking responsive actions to address groundwater and soil issues. Expenditures in 2011 to evaluate and remediate these sites were not material.
Additional sites may be identified for environmental remediation in the future, including properties previously transferred and with respect to which the Company may have contractual indemnification obligations.

Available Information

Our web site is located at www.wabco-auto.com. Our periodic reports and all amendments to those reports required to be filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 are available free of charge through the web site. During the period covered by this report, we posted our periodic reports on Form 10-Q and our current reports on Form 8-K and any amendments to those documents to our web site as soon as such reports were filed or furnished electronically with the Securities Exchange Commission (“SEC”). We will continue to post to our web site such reports and amendments as soon as reasonably practicable after such reports are filed with or furnished to the SEC.

Code of Conduct and Ethics

Our Code of Conduct and Ethics, which applies to all employees, including all executive officers and senior financial officers and directors, is posted on our web site www.wabco-auto.com. The Code of Conduct and Ethics is compliant with Item 406 of SEC Regulation S-K and the NYSE corporate governance listing standards. Any changes to the Code of Conduct and Ethics that affect the provisions required by Item 406 of Regulation S-K will also be disclosed on the web site.

Any waivers of the Code of Conduct and Ethics for our executive officers, directors or senior financial officers must be approved by our Audit Committee and those waivers, if any are ever granted, would be disclosed on our web site under the caption “Exemptions to the Code of Conduct and Ethics.” There have been no waivers to the Code of Conduct and Ethics.


11

Table of Contents


ITEM 1A.      RISK FACTORS
Any of the following factors could have a material adverse affect on our future operating results as well as other factors included in “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations - Information Concerning Forward Looking Statements.”
Risks Relating to Our Business
Our sales could decline due to macro-economic factors, cyclicality of the industry, regulatory changes and other factors outside of our control.
Changes in economic conditions, cyclical downturns in our industry, regulatory changes impacting the purchasing patterns of commercial vehicles, and changes in the local economies of the countries or regions in which we sell our products, such as changes in consumer confidence, increases in interest rates and increases in unemployment, could affect demand for our products, which could negatively affect our business and results of operations.
Demand for new trucks and buses in the markets in which we operate has a significant impact on our sales. In 2011, heavy truck and bus production has increased in Europe, our largest market which accounted for approximately 62% of our total sales. Adverse economic conditions in our markets, particularly in Europe, and other factors may cause our customers to reduce truck and bus production, which could have an adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.
A global recession would negatively impact our customers and result in reduced demand for our products, which would therefore have a significant negative impact on our business.                
During the recent global recession, the credit markets experienced a period of unprecedented turmoil and upheaval characterized by significantly reduced availability of credit and increased borrowing costs.  The disruptions in the credit markets and impacts of the global recession negatively impacted consumer spending patterns and caused our customers to reduce truck and bus production.  While the commercial vehicle industry experienced a significant recovery in 2010 and 2011 in our more developed markets, a further or "double dip" global recession could result in tightening of the still-fragile credit markets, which would cause our customers to again reduce truck and bus production, which would have a negative impact on our business and results of operations, our operating cash flows and our financial condition.
Our exposure to exchange rate fluctuations on cross border transactions and the translation of local currency results into U.S. dollars could negatively impact our results of operations.
We conduct business through subsidiaries in many different countries, and fluctuations in currency exchange rates have a significant impact on the reported results of our operations, which are presented in U.S. dollars. In 2011, approximately 91% of our combined sales occurred outside of the United States. A significant and growing portion of our products are manufactured in best-cost countries and sold in various countries. Cross border transactions, both with external parties and intercompany relationships, result in increased exposure to foreign currency exchange effects. Accordingly, significant changes in the exchange rates of the euro, U.S. dollar and other applicable currencies could cause fluctuations in the reported results of our operations that could negatively affect our results of operations. Additionally, our results of operations are translated into U.S. dollars for reporting purposes. The strengthening or weakening of the U.S. dollar results in unfavorable or favorable translation effects as the results of foreign locations are translated into U.S. dollars.


We are subject to general risks associated with our foreign operations.
In addition to the currency exchange risks inherent in operating in many different foreign countries, there are other risks inherent in our international operations.
The risks related to our foreign operations that we more often face in the normal course of business include:
changes in non-U.S. tax law, increases in non-U.S. tax rates and the amount of non-U.S. earnings relative to total combined earnings could change and impact our combined tax rate;
foreign earnings may be subject to withholding requirements or the imposition of tariffs, price or exchange controls, or other restrictions;
general economic and political conditions in countries where we operate may have an adverse effect on our operations in those countries;
we may have difficulty complying with a variety of foreign laws and regulations, some of which may conflict with

12

Table of Contents

United States law, and the uncertainty created by this legal environment could limit our ability to effectively enforce our rights in certain markets; and
in several of the countries in which we do business, we rely upon the ongoing performance of our joint venture partners who bear risks similar to our risks and also may include obligations they have under related shareholders' agreements and risk of being denied access to the capital markets which could lead to resource demands on the Company in order to maintain or advance its strategy.
 
The ability to manage these risks could be difficult and may limit our operations and make the manufacture and distribution of our products internationally more difficult, which could negatively affect our business and results of operations.
If we are unable to obtain component parts or obtain them at reasonable price levels, our ability to maintain existing sales margins may be affected.
We purchase a broad range of materials and components throughout the world in connection with our manufacturing activities. Major items include electronic components and parts containing aluminum, steel, copper, zinc, rubber and plastics. The cost of components and parts, and the raw materials used therein, represents a significant portion of our total costs. Price increases of the underlying commodities may adversely affect our results of operations. Although we maintain alternative sources for components and parts, our business is subject to the risk of price fluctuations and periodic delays in the delivery of certain raw materials. The sudden inability of a supplier to deliver components or to do so at reasonable prices could have a temporary adverse effect on our production of certain products or the cost at which we can produce those products. Any change in the supply or price of raw materials could materially adversely affect our future business and results of operations.
If we are not able to maintain good relations with our employees, we could suffer work stoppages that could negatively affect our business and results of operations.
Employees located in our sites in Europe, Asia and South America are subject to collective bargaining, with internal company agreements or external agreements at the region or country level. Currently 50% of our workforce is covered by collective bargaining agreements and most of those agreements expire during 2012. These employees' right to strike is typically protected by law and union membership is confidential information which does not have to be provided to the employer. Our U.S. facilities are non-union. Any disputes with our employee base could result in work stoppages or labor protests, which could disrupt our operations. Any such labor disputes could negatively affect our business and results of operations.
We are dependent on key customers.
We rely on several key customers. For the fiscal year ending December 31, 2011, sales to our top three customers accounted for approximately 12% (Daimler), 11% (Volvo) and 6% (Meritor WABCO - our 50%-owned joint venture in North America), respectively, of our sales, and sales to our top ten customers accounted for approximately 52% of our sales. Many of our customers place orders for products on an as-needed basis and operate in cyclical industries and, as a result, their order levels have varied from period to period in the past and may vary significantly in the future. Such customer orders are dependent upon their markets and customers and may be subject to delays or cancellations. As a result of dependence on our key customers, we have experienced and could experience in the future a material adverse effect on our business and results of operations if any of the following were to occur:
the loss of any key customer, in whole or in part;
a declining market in which customers reduce orders or demand reduced prices; or
a strike or work stoppage at a key customer facility, which could affect both its suppliers and customers.
 
If there are changes in the environmental or other regulations that affect one or more of our current or future products, it could have a negative impact on our business and results of operations.
We are currently subject to various environmental and other regulations in the U.S. and internationally. A risk of environmental liability is inherent in our current and former manufacturing activities. Under certain environmental laws, we could be held jointly and severally responsible for the remediation of any hazardous substance contamination at our past and present facilities and at third party waste disposal sites and could also be held liable for damages to natural resources and any consequences arising out of human exposure to such substances or other environmental damage. While we have a number of proactive programs underway to minimize the impact of the production and use of our products on the environment and believe that we are in substantial compliance with environmental laws and regulations, we cannot predict whether there will be changes in the environmental regulations affecting our products.

13

Table of Contents

Any changes in the environmental and other regulations which affect our current or future products could have a negative impact on our business if we are unable to adjust our product offering to comply with such regulatory changes. In addition, it is possible that we will incur increased costs as a result of complying with environmental regulations, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.
We may be subject to product liability, warranty and recall claims, which may increase the costs of doing business and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
We are subject to a risk of product liability or warranty claims if our products actually or allegedly fail to perform as expected or the use of our products results, or are alleged to result, in bodily injury and/or property damage. While we maintain reasonable limits of insurance coverage to appropriately respond to such exposures, large product liability claims, if made, could exceed our insurance coverage limits and insurance may not continue to be available on commercially acceptable terms, if at all. We cannot assure you that we will not incur significant costs to defend these claims or that we will not experience any product liability losses in the future. In addition, if any of our designed products are or are alleged to be defective, we may be required to participate in recalls and exchanges of such products. In the past five years, our warranty expense has fluctuated between approximately 1.3% and 1.6% of sales on an annual basis. Individual quarters were above or below the annual averages. The future cost associated with providing product warranties and/or bearing the cost of repair or replacement of our products could exceed our historical experience and have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.
We are required to plan our capacity well in advance of production and our success depends on having available capacity and effectively using it.
We principally compete for new business at the beginning of the development of our customers' new products. Our customers' new product development generally begins significantly prior to the marketing and production of their new products and our supply of our products generally lasts for the life of our customers' products. Nevertheless, our customers may move business to other suppliers or request price reductions during the life cycle of a product. The long development and sales cycle of our new products, combined with the specialized nature of many of our facilities and the resulting difficulty in shifting work from one facility to another, could result in variances in capacity utilization. In order to meet our customers' requirements, we may be required to supply our customers regardless of cost and consequently we may suffer an adverse impact on our operating profit margins and results of operations.
We must continue to make technological advances, or we may not be able to successfully compete in our industry.
We operate in an industry in which technological advancements are necessary to remain competitive. Accordingly, we devote substantial resources to improve already technologically complex products and to remain a leader in technological innovation. However, if we fail to continue to make technological improvements or our competitors develop technologically superior products, it could have an adverse effect on our operating results or financial condition.
Risks Relating to the Separation

We have agreed to indemnify Trane for taxes and related losses resulting from certain actions that may cause the Distribution to fail to qualify as a tax-free transaction.
 
Trane has received a private letter ruling from the Internal Revenue Service (“IRS”) substantially to the effect that the Distribution qualifies as tax-free for U.S. federal income tax purposes under Section 355 of the Internal Revenue Code (“the Code”). In addition, Trane has received an opinion of Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom LLP, tax counsel to Trane, substantially to the effect that the Distribution will qualify as tax-free to Trane, us and our shareholders under Section 355 and related provisions of the Code. The ruling and opinion were based on, among other things, certain assumptions as well as on the accuracy of certain factual representations and statements made by Trane and us. In rendering its ruling, the IRS also relied on certain covenants that WABCO and Trane entered into, including the adherence to certain restrictions on Trane's and WABCO's future actions.

Notwithstanding receipt by Trane of the private letter ruling and the opinion of counsel, the IRS could assert that the Distribution should be treated as a taxable transaction. If the Distribution fails to qualify for tax-free treatment, then Trane would recognize a gain in an amount equal to the excess of (i) the fair market value of our common stock distributed to the Trane shareholders over (ii) Trane's tax basis in such common stock. Under the terms of the Tax Sharing Agreement, in the event the Distribution were to fail to qualify as a tax-free reorganization and such failure was not the result of actions taken after the distribution by Trane or any of its subsidiaries or shareholders, we would be responsible for all taxes imposed on Trane as a result thereof. In addition, each Trane shareholder who received our common stock in the Distribution generally would be

14

Table of Contents

treated as having received a taxable Distribution in an amount equal to the fair market value of our common stock received (including any fractional share sold on behalf of the shareholder), which would be taxable as a dividend to the extent of the shareholder's ratable share of Trane's current and accumulated earnings and profits (as increased to reflect any current income including any gain recognized by Trane on the taxable distribution). The balance, if any, of the Distribution would be treated as a nontaxable return of capital to the extent of the Trane shareholder's tax basis in its Trane stock, with any remaining amount being taxed as capital gain. Our obligation to indemnify Trane under the Tax Sharing Agreement if the Distribution fails to qualify for tax-free treatment could be substantial if triggered, and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

We are responsible for certain of Trane's contingent and other corporate liabilities.

Under the Indemnification and Cooperation Agreement, the Separation and Distribution Agreement and the Tax Sharing Agreement, our wholly-owned subsidiary WABCO Europe BVBA has assumed and is responsible for certain contingent liabilities related to Trane's business (including certain associated costs and expenses, whether arising prior to, at or after the Distribution) and will indemnify Trane for these liabilities. Among the contingent liabilities against which we will indemnify Trane and the other indemnities, are liabilities associated with certain non-U.S. tax liabilities and certain U.S. and non-U.S. environmental liabilities associated with certain Trane entities.
We will indemnify Trane, Ideal Standard International, including certain former European subsidiaries and affiliates of the former American Standard group, and their respective owners against any fines associated with an investigation into alleged infringement of European Union competition regulations.

As part of a multi-company investigation, American Standard and certain of its European subsidiaries engaged in the Bath and Kitchen business were charged by the European Commission for alleged infringements of European Union competition rules relating to the distribution of bathroom fixtures and fittings in a number of European countries. Pursuant to the Indemnification and Cooperation Agreement, WABCO Europe BVBA (an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of WABCO) will be responsible for, and will indemnify American Standard (now Trane) and Ideal Standard International (including certain subsidiaries engaged, or formerly engaged in the Bath and Kitchen business) and their respective affiliates. As required by the Indemnification and Cooperation agreement, WABCO paid the fine amount into escrow on August 30, 2010 and those funds were subsequently released from escrow and paid to the Commission. After reviewing all of the elements of the case, WABCO decided to appeal the decision in order to try to have the fine reduced. On September 8, 2010, WABCO filed its appeal in the General Court of the European Union, located in Luxembourg. It is expected that a decision on the appeal will take at least five years from the date of our appeal. See Item 3. “Legal Proceedings” for additional discussion of the procedural history, response, hearing and appeals process related to the European Commission investigation.

Risks Relating to Our Common Stock
Your percentage ownership in WABCO may be diluted in the future.
Your percentage ownership in WABCO may be diluted in the future because of equity awards that have already been granted and that we expect will be granted to our directors and officers in the future under our Omnibus Incentive Plan. In addition, we may in the future issue additional equity securities, subject to limitations imposed by the Tax Sharing Agreement, in order to fund working capital needs, capital expenditures and product development, or to make acquisitions and other investments, which may dilute your ownership interest.
We cannot assure you that we will pay any dividends or repurchase shares.
While we have historically returned value to shareholders in the form of share repurchases and/or dividends, our ability to repurchase shares and pay dividends is limited by available cash, contingent liabilities and surplus. Moreover, all decisions regarding the declaration and payment of dividends and share repurchases will be at the sole discretion of our Board and will be evaluated from time to time in light of our financial condition, earnings, capital requirements of our business, covenants associated with certain debt obligations, legal requirements, regulatory constraints, industry practice and other factors that our Board deems relevant.

Our shareholder rights plan and provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated by-laws, and of Delaware law may prevent or delay an acquisition of our company, which could decrease the trading price of our common stock.
Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, amended and restated by-laws and Delaware law

15

Table of Contents

contain provisions that are intended to deter coercive takeover practices and inadequate takeover bids by making such practices or bids unacceptably expensive to the raider and to encourage prospective acquirers to negotiate with our Board of Directors rather than to attempt a hostile takeover. These provisions include, among others:
a Board of Directors that is divided into three classes with staggered terms;
elimination of the right of our shareholders to act by written consent;
rules regarding how shareholders may present proposals or nominate directors for election at shareholder meetings;
the right of our Board to issue preferred stock without shareholder approval; and
limitations on the right of shareholders to remove directors.
Delaware law also imposes some restrictions on mergers and other business combinations between us and any holder of 15% or more of our outstanding common stock.
On July 13, 2007, our Board adopted a shareholder rights plan, which provides, among other things, that when specified events occur, our shareholders will be entitled to purchase from us a newly created series of junior preferred stock. The preferred stock purchase rights are triggered by the earlier to occur of (i) ten business days (or a later date determined by our Board of Directors before the rights are separated from our common stock) after the public announcement that a person or group has become an “acquiring person” by acquiring beneficial ownership of 15% or more of our outstanding common stock or (ii) ten business days (or a later date determined by our Board before the rights are separated from our common stock) after a person or group begins a tender or exchange offer that, if completed, would result in that person or group becoming an acquiring person. The issuance of preferred stock pursuant to the shareholder rights plan would cause substantial dilution to a person or group that attempts to acquire us on terms not approved by our Board of Directors.
We believe these provisions protect our shareholders from coercive or otherwise unfair takeover tactics by requiring potential acquirers to negotiate with our Board and by providing our Board with more time to assess any acquisition proposal. These provisions are not intended to make our company immune from takeovers. However, these provisions apply even if the offer may be considered beneficial by some shareholders and could delay or prevent an acquisition that our Board determines is not in the best interests of our company and our shareholders.


16

Table of Contents


ITEM 1B.      UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS
None.

ITEM 2.      PROPERTIES
As of February 17, 2012, we conducted our manufacturing activities at 18 plants in 10 countries.
Location
  
Major Products Manufactured at Location
Campinas, Brazil
  
Vehicle control systems
Jinan, China (2 plants)
  
Braking systems and Compressors
Qingdao, China
  
Braking systems
Taishan, China
 
Foundation brakes
Claye-Souilly, France
  
Vehicle control systems
Hanover, Germany
  
Vehicle control systems
Gronau, Germany
  
Compressors and hydraulics
Mannheim, Germany
  
Foundation brakes
Ambattur, India
 
Vehicle control systems
Jamshedpur, India
  
Vehicle control systems
Mahindra World City, India
 
Vehicle control systems
Meppel, Netherlands
  
Actuators
Pyungtaek, Korea
  
Braking systems
Stanowice, Poland
  
Remanufactured products
Wroclaw, Poland
  
Vehicle control systems
Charleston, United States
  
Compressors
Rochester Hills, United States
 
Remanufactured products
We own all of the plants described above, except for Claye-Souilly, France; Jinan, China; Taishan, China; Rochester Hills, U.S. and Charleston, U.S.; which are leased. Our properties are generally in good condition, are well maintained, and are generally suitable and adequate to carry out our business. In 2011, the manufacturing plants, taken as a whole, met our capacity needs.
We also own or lease warehouse and office space for administrative and sales staff. Our headquarters, located in Brussels, Belgium, and our executive offices, located in Piscataway, New Jersey, are leased.

ITEM 3.      LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
We may be party to a variety of legal proceedings with respect to environmental related, employee related, product related, and general liability and automotive litigation related matters that arise in the normal course of our business. While the results of these legal proceedings cannot be predicted with certainty, management believes that the final outcome of these proceedings will not have a material adverse effect on our combined results of operations or financial position. For more information on current legal proceedings, refer to Note 14 of Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

ITEM 4.      RESERVED

17

Table of Contents


ITEM 4A.      EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE REGISTRANT

The following table sets forth certain information as of February 17, 2012 with respect to each person who is an executive officer of the Company:

Name
Age
Position(s)
Jacques Esculier
52
Chairman of the Board of Directors and Chief Executive Officer
Ulrich Michel
49
Chief Financial Officer
Kevin Tarrant
54
Chief Human Resources Officer
Nikhil M. Varty
47
Vice President, Compression & Braking
Todd Weinblatt
42
Vice President and Controller
Jean-Christophe Figueroa
48
Vice President, Vehicle Dynamics and Controls
Vincent Pickering
43
Chief Legal Officer and Secretary

Each officer of the Company is appointed by the Board of Directors to a term of office expiring on the date of the first Board meeting after the Annual Meeting of Shareholders next succeeding his or her appointment or such officer's earlier resignation or removal.

Set forth below is the principal occupation of each of the executive officers named above during the past five years.

  Jacques Esculier has served as our Chief Executive Officer and director since July 2007. In May 2009, he was appointed Chairman of our Board of Directors. Prior to July 2007, Mr. Esculier served as Vice President of Trane and President of its Vehicle Control Systems business, a position he had held since January 2004. Prior to holding that position, Mr. Esculier served in the capacity of Business Leader for the Trane Commercial Systems' Europe, Middle East, Africa, India & Asia Region from 2002 through January 2004. Prior to joining Trane in 2002, Mr. Esculier spent more than six years in leadership positions at AlliedSignal/Honeywell. He was Vice President and General Manager of Environmental Control and Power Systems Enterprise based in Los Angeles, and Vice President of Aftermarket Services-Asia Pacific based in Singapore.

Ulrich Michel has served as our Chief Financial Officer since July 2007. Prior to July 2007, Mr. Michel served as Chief Financial Officer of Trane's Vehicle Control Systems business, a position he had held since April 2005. Prior to holding that position, Mr. Michel served in the capacity of Chief Financial Officer for the Trane Commercial Systems' Europe, Middle East, Africa & India Region from 2003 through April 2005. Prior to joining Trane in 2003, Mr. Michel spent more than six years in financial leadership positions at AlliedSignal/Honeywell with areas of focus including mergers and acquisitions, the Specialty Chemicals business, and the Control Products business in Europe. Before joining AlliedSignal/Honeywell, Mr. Michel spent eight years at Price Waterhouse.

Kevin Tarrant has served as our Chief Human Resources Officer since July 2007. Prior to July 2007, Mr. Tarrant served for two years as Vice President, Global Organization Effectiveness for Arrow Electronics in Melville, New York. Prior to that, Mr. Tarrant was Senior Vice President of Human Resources for First Data Resources in Denver, Colorado from 2003 to 2005 after having served as Vice President of Human Resources for First Data's Western Union International business headquartered in Paris, France from 2002 to 2003. Before joining First Data, Mr. Tarrant spent 10 years at the headquarters and business-unit level working for various Dun & Bradstreet Corporation businesses and six years at the Monsanto Company's chemical controls businesses.

Nikhil M. Varty has served as our Vice President, Compression and Braking since July 2007. Prior to July 2007, Mr. Varty served as Vice President, Compression and Braking of Trane's Vehicle Control Systems business, a position he has held since January 2005. Prior to holding that position, Mr. Varty served in the capacity of Chief Financial Officer of Trane's Vehicle Control Systems business. Prior to joining Trane in June 2001, Mr. Varty had more than 10 years of national and international senior level finance roles with Great Lakes Chemical Corp., AlliedSignal/Honeywell and Coopers & Lybrand.

Todd Weinblatt has served as our Vice President and Controller since July 2007. Prior to July 2007, Mr. Weinblatt served as Assistant Controller of Trane, a position he had held since 2004. Before joining Trane, Mr. Weinblatt served as Director-Accounting Policy and External Reporting at The Dun & Bradstreet Corporation. His prior experience includes six years at Lucent Technologies Inc., where he was a Senior Manager of Accounting Policy and Mergers and Acquisitions. He began his career with Coopers & Lybrand, where he spent five years as an auditor.

18

Table of Contents


Jean-Christophe Figueroa has served as our Vice President, Vehicle Dynamics and Controls since July 2007. Prior to July 2007, Mr. Figueroa served in a similar capacity within Trane's Vehicle Control Systems business. Mr. Figueroa joined Trane in 2005 from tier-1 automotive supplier Valeo where he had been Group Vice President, Purchasing, based in Paris, France. Mr. Figueroa spent 13 years in senior management business and purchasing positions for Valeo, including leadership of the Automotive Climate Control business in both Mexico and subsequently Western Europe. Prior to joining Valeo, Mr. Figueroa spent seven years with Pierburg, Mexico, in various leadership positions in logistics, purchasing and program management.

Vincent Pickering has served as our Chief Legal Officer and Secretary since September 2010. Prior to joining WABCO, Mr. Pickering served as the Associate General Counsel for the Worldwide Licensing and Pricing Division of Microsoft Corp. for eight years. Prior to working at Microsoft, Mr. Pickering worked both in-house and in private practice, representing companies across a diverse range of industries that include the telecommunications and energy sectors.


19

Table of Contents



PART II
ITEM 5.
MARKET FOR THE REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
Our common stock is listed on NYSE under the symbol “WBC.” Our Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, authorizes the Company to issue up to 400,000,000 shares of common stock, par value $.01 per share, and 4,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $.01 per share, all of which have been designated by our Board of Directors as a series of Junior Participating Cumulative Preferred Stock. We also have a rights agreement. Pursuant to the rights agreement, when triggered in certain takeover situations, one preferred stock purchase right will be issued for each outstanding share of our common stock.
As of February 8, 2012, there were 541 holders of record of the Company's common stock. A significant number of the outstanding shares of common stock which are beneficially owned by individuals or entities are registered in the name of a nominee of The Depository Trust Company, a securities depository for banks and brokerage firms. We believe that there are approximately 29,794 beneficial owners of our common stock as of February 6, 2012.
We have not declared and paid any cash dividends in 2010 or 2011. Our last cash dividend was paid ($0.07 per share) in the first quarter of 2009. We continuously consider ways to return capital to our stockholders, either through our open market repurchase program and/or through the payment of cash dividends.
Set forth below are the high and low sales prices for shares of our common stock for each quarterly period of 2010 and 2011.  
2010  
High   
Low   
First quarter
$
31.04

$
24.09

Second quarter
$
36.92

$
26.64

Third quarter
$
43.29

$
30.74

Fourth quarter
$
60.95

$
41.19

2011  
 
 
First quarter
$
65.53

$
55.73

Second quarter
$
75.00

$
59.00

Third quarter
$
73.15

$
36.33

Fourth quarter
$
52.48

$
34.17


ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

Our Board of Directors has approved an open market stock repurchase program. On May 26, 2011, the Board of Directors approved the purchase of shares in an amount not to exceed $400 million, which expires on May 31, 2013. The unexpended balance of $219,505,568 under that authorization as of December 31, 2011 will continue to be used to repurchase shares in the future subject to our evaluation of market conditions and other factors. A summary of the repurchase activity for 2011 follows.

20

Table of Contents

Period
 
Total Number of Shares Purchased
Average price Paid per Share
Total Number of Shares Purchases as Part of Publicly Announced Plans or Programs
Maximum Dollar Value of shares that May Yet Be Purchased Under the Plans or Programs (a)
April 1 - April 30
 

$


$

May 1 - May 31
 

$


$

June 1 - June 30
 
794,030

$
64.12

794,030

$
349,085,169

Total second quarter
 
794,030

$
64.12

794,030

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
July 1 - July 31
 
300,604

$
68.63

300,604

$
328,455,777

August 1 - August 31
 
426,907

$
51.51

426,907

$
306,466,611

September 1 - September 30
 
876,713

$
42.97

876,713

$
268,794,618

Total third quarter
 
1,604,224

$
50.05

1,604,224

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
October 1 - October 31
 
306,694

$
41.84

306,694

$
255,961,522

November 1 - November 30
 
479,900

$
45.76

479,900

$
234,001,794

December 1 - December 31
 
335,621

$
43.19

335,621

$
219,505,568

Total fourth quarter
 
1,122,215

$
43.92

1,122,215

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total through December 31, 2011
 
3,520,469

$
51.27

3,520,469

$
219,505,568


All share repurchases were effected in accordance with the safe harbor provisions of Rule 10b-18 of the Exchange Act.

PERFORMANCE GRAPH
The following graph and table compare the cumulative total shareholder's return on our common stock from August 1, 2007 through December 31, 2011, with the Standard & Poor's 500 Index and the Standard & Poor's Auto Parts & Equipment Index. The table and graph use data supplied by the Compustat Services unit of Standard & Poor's Corporation. The comparisons reflected in the graph and table are not intended to forecast the future performance of the common stock and may not be indicative of such future performance.
Total Shareholder Returns


21

Table of Contents


 
7/31/2007
12/31/2007
12/31/2008
12/31/2009
12/31/2010
12/31/2011
WABCO Holdings, Inc.
100
104.67

33.30

54.71

129.24

92.06

S&P 500 Index
100
101.79

64.13

81.10

93.32

95.29

S&P 500 Auto Parts & Equipment Index
100
96.19

49.38

76.38

109.06

89.71


22

Table of Contents


ITEM 6.
SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
 
(Amounts in millions, except share and per share data) 
 
Year Ended December 31,  
 
2011
 
2010  
 
2009  
 
2008  
 
2007 
Income Statement Data:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales
 
$
2,794.1

 
$
2,175.7

 
$
1,491.5

 
$
2,588.0

 
$
2,415.9

Cost of sales
 
1,984.6

 
1,556.6

 
1,126.7

 
1,883.5

 
1,760.5

Streamlining expenses (a)
 
1.5

 
4.0

 
37.0

 
10.5

 
3.7

Gross profit
 
808.0

 
615.1

 
327.8

 
694.0

 
651.7

Costs and expenses:
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Selling and administrative expenses
 
326.6

 
307.4

 
251.9

 
316.8

 
290.7

Product engineering expenses
 
105.1

 
85.9

 
75.2

 
92.9

 
84.2

Streamlining (income) / expenses (a)
 
0.6

 
(0.8
)
 
19.8

 
26.4

 
9.1

Other operating expense / (income), net
 
5.8

 
5.0

 
(4.2
)
 
11.4

 
26.0

Operating income / (loss)
 
369.9

 
217.6

 
(14.9
)
 
246.5

 
241.7

European Commission fine indemnification
 

 
(400.4
)
 

 

 

Equity income of unconsolidated joint ventures
 
16.5

 
9.9

 
3.1

 
8.1

 
9.1

Other non-operating (expense), net
 
(2.9
)
 
(2.2
)
 
(5.3
)
 
(4.3
)
 
(6.6
)
Income from indemnification and other settlements
 
23.1

 

 
41.3

 

 

Fair value adjustment (charge) of the noncontrolling interest prior to taking control
 

 

 
(11.5
)
 

 

Interest (expense) / income, net
 
(1.7
)
 
(2.2
)
 
0.5

 
3.7

 
(4.5
)
(Loss) / income before income taxes
 
404.9

 
(177.3
)
 
13.2

 
254.0

 
239.7

Income tax expense / (benefit) (b)
 
36.7

 
36.9

 
(10.7
)
 
38.2

 
111.3

Net (loss) / income including noncontrolling interests
 
368.2

 
(214.2
)
 
23.9

 
215.8

 
128.4

Less: net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
 
11.2

 
11.9

 
5.1

 
2.5

 
3.0

Net (loss) / income
 
$
357.0

 
$
(226.1
)
 
$
18.8

 
$
213.3

 
$
125.4

Per share:
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
 
$
5.35

 
$
(3.50
)
 
$
0.29

 
$
3.28

 
1.85

Diluted
 
$
5.19

 
$
(3.50
)
 
$
0.29

 
$
3.24

 
1.81

Average number of outstanding common shares:
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
 
66,693,064

 
64,562,222

 
64,024,237

 
65,113,404

 
67,887,919

Diluted
 
68,829,440

 
64,562,222

 
65,030,557

 
65,871,941

 
69,270,661

Balance Sheet Data  (at end of period):
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Total assets
 
$
1,623.2

 
$
1,524.9

 
$
1,715.6

 
$
1,776.0

 
$
1,794.2

Total debt
 
$
78.2

 
$
113.5

 
$
156.1

 
$
250.0

 
$
126.2

Total Shareholders' equity
 
$
587.2

 
$
412.3

 
$
640.1

 
$
601.5

 
$
607.6

Cash dividends per common share
 
$

 
$

 
$
0.07

 
$
0.28

 
0.14

 
Prior to July 31, 2007, the historical selected financial data was derived from the consolidated financial statements and accounting records of Trane, principally representing the Vehicle Control Systems segment, using the historical results of operations, and historical basis of assets and liabilities of the Vehicle Control Systems segment and reflecting Trane's net investment in the Vehicle Control Systems segment through July 31, 2007.

(a) Due to the materiality of the streamlining expenses related to cost of sales during 2009, the amounts have been shown separately and comparable periods have been adjusted.


23

Table of Contents

(b) The income tax provision for 2011 includes taxes on earnings in profitable jurisdictions offset by benefits related to ongoing foreign tax planning activities, a decrease in a valuation allowance, and the release of certain tax accruals as a consequence of the settlement of foreign tax audits and the expiration of a statute of limitation. Additionally, the Company provided a tax provision of $12.7 million during the fourth quarter due to the Company's decision to repatriate earnings from a foreign affiliate of approximately $299 million.

The income tax provision for 2010 includes taxes on earnings in profitable jurisdictions and benefits related to ongoing foreign tax planning activities. In addition, the tax provision for 2010 excludes any benefit related to the indemnification payment of approximately $400 million for the EC fine. During the third quarter of 2010, an uncertain tax position of approximately $135.8 million was recorded for the tax deduction related to the EC fine. The entity that will claim a deduction for $396.9 million of the EC fine has existing net operating losses resulting in a deferred tax asset in a foreign jurisdiction for which a full valuation allowance has been provided. Consequently, as this tax deduction would otherwise increase the deferred tax asset related to the net operating losses for which a full valuation allowance is provided, the uncertain tax position of $134.9 million is recorded as a reduction of the related deferred tax asset on the balance sheet.

The income tax benefit for 2009 includes a net benefit of $13.0 million, principally related to the release of tax accruals as a consequence of the settlement of a foreign tax audit.

The income tax provision for 2008 includes a net benefit of $8.3 million, principally related to a reduction of an unrecognized tax benefit recorded in the third quarter of 2007 related to the separation of the WABCO business from Trane. This change in estimate resulted from the filing of the Company's and Trane's 2007 U.S. Federal income tax returns in September 2008. The 2008 effective income tax rate was 15.2%.

The income tax provision for 2007 includes a $50.7 million charge related to the separation of the WABCO business from Trane and a charge of $10.2 million related to the net reduction in deferred tax assets pursuant to rate changes in Germany, UK and China, partially offset by a $7.5 million benefit related to the settlement of a foreign tax audit during the second quarter, and benefits associated with foreign tax planning for 2007 following WABCO's separation from Trane. The combined effects of the tax benefits and charge, with other ongoing tax planning activities resulted in an effective income tax rate of 47.0%.

For a comparative analysis of certain line items in the Income Statement Data section of this table, see Item 7. “Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” which follows.

24

Table of Contents


ITEM 7.
MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
This discussion summarizes the significant factors affecting the results of operations and financial condition of WABCO during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009 and should be read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto included elsewhere herein. Certain information in this discussion and analysis regarding industry outlook, our expectations regarding the future performance of our business and other non-historical statements are forward-looking statements. These forward-looking statements are subject to numerous risks and uncertainties, including, but not limited to, the risks and uncertainties described in “Risk Factors” above. Our actual results may differ materially from those contained in any forward-looking statements. You should read the following discussion together with the sections entitled “Risk Factors,” “Information Concerning Forward-Looking Statements,” “Selected Financial Information,” “Liquidity and Capital Resources” and consolidated financial statements and related notes thereto included elsewhere herein .
Executive Overview

During 2011, the commercial vehicle industry continued to grow globally and our sales worldwide increased by 28% (22% excluding foreign currency translation effects) compared with the same period a year ago, marking a record level of annual sales. Overall, WABCO continued in 2011 to outperform the global market for truck and bus production.

Continuing to demonstrate the importance of emerging markets, China, India and Brazil accounted for 58% of the world's truck and bus production in 2011. The Company continued to benefit from its well anchored position in these emerging economies, and has successfully maintained an increasing level of adoption of WABCO technologies and systems, resulting in a higher value of WABCO content per vehicle.

WABCO's global aftermarket sales increased by 13% (8% excluding foreign currency translation effects), compared with the same period a year ago, resulting in record aftermarket revenues. This performance demonstrates the continued success of the Company's aftermarket strategies initiated several years ago.

In the first quarter of 2011, WABCO celebrated the grand opening of its fourth production facility in China. The new Jinan-based factory features the Company's Six Sigma Lean program, which uses world-class methods to combine quality management with process efficiency, starting with suppliers and connecting through to customers.

Throughout 2011, WABCO continued to transform sales growth into strong profitability, achieving a 27% incremental operating profit margin (excluding foreign currency translation effects), resulting in an annual record. Also during 2011, WABCO's Operating System continued to provide fast and flexible responses to market conditions, delivering $63.2 million of materials and conversion productivity. Gross materials productivity in 2011 represented 5.3% of total materials cost but, as anticipated, the impact of commodity inflation reduced net materials productivity to 3.3%. Conversion productivity in 2011 reached a record level of 5.9%, a major achievement, particularly during a series of consecutive quarters of high growth.
Our Markets and Our Customers
Our sales are affected by changes in truck and bus (T&B) production. Europe is our largest geographic market and sales to T&B OEMs represent our largest customer group. The table below shows the relationship between our European sales to T&B OEMs, which account for approximately 57% of our global sales to T&B OEMs, and European T&B production for the last five years. Sales data is shown at a constant euro to U.S. dollar exchange rate for year to year comparability and to make comparisons to unit production meaningful. Over the past five years, our sales have outperformed the growth in European T&B production by an average of 3% per year.
Year to Year Change
    
2007
 
2008
 
2009
 
2010
 
2011
Sales to European T&B OEMs (at a constant FX rate)
    
12
%
 
4
%
 
(58
)%
 
60
%
 
34
%
European T&B Production
    
10
%
 
4
%
 
(62
)%
 
52
%
 
31
%

      In general, our sales track directionally with truck and bus builds. However, individual year to year sales changes are also influenced by other factors such as timing of orders and deliveries to T&B OEM customers, application content, new product introduction, price and introduction of new customer platforms. The level of truck build activity is influenced by general economic conditions, including interest rate levels and inflation.

25

Table of Contents

      
Our aftermarket sales account for approximately 23% of total sales and are affected by a variety of factors: content on specific vehicles and breadth of our product range, number of commercial trucks in active operation, truck age, type of vehicles built, miles driven, demand for transported goods and overall economic activity. On average, our aftermarket sales (on a constant exchange to the U.S. dollar rate) have grown by 6% annually for the last five years as shown in the table below.
 
Year to Year Change  
2007
2008
2009
2010
2011
Average
Change 
Aftermarket Sales (at Constant FX rate)
7
%
1
%
(6
)%
22
%
8
%
6
%
Distribution of WABCO's Sales by Major End-Markets, Product Types and Geography
 
 
2011  
 
2010  
 
2009
Major End-Markets
 
 
 
 
 
OE Manufacturers:
 
 
 
 
 
   Truck & Bus products
64
%
 
63
%
 
55
%
   Trailer products
9
%
 
7
%
 
9
%
   Car products
4
%
 
4
%
 
4
%
Aftermarket
23
%
 
26
%
 
32
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
Geography:
 

 
 

 
 

   Europe
62
%
 
60
%
 
65
%
   North America
9
%
 
8
%
 
8
%
   South America
7
%
 
7
%
 
6
%
   Asia
19
%
 
22
%
 
18
%
   Other
3
%
 
3
%
 
3
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
Our largest customer is Daimler, which accounts for approximately 12% of our sales. Volvo accounted for 11% of our sales in 2011. Other key customers include Ashok Leyland, BMW, China National Heavy Truck Corporation (CNHTC), Cummins, Fiat (Iveco), Hino, Hyundai, Krone, MAN Nutzfahrzeuge AG (MAN), Meritor, Meritor WABCO (a joint venture), Paccar (DAF Trucks N.V. (DAF), Kenworth, Leyland and Peterbilt), First Automobile Works, Otto Sauer Achsenfabrik (SAF), Scania, Schmitz Cargobull AG, TATA Motors and ZF Friedrichshafen AG (ZF). For the fiscal years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, our top 10 customers accounted for approximately 52% and 51% of our sales, respectively.
Results of Operations
Approximately 91% of our sales are outside the U.S. and therefore, changes in exchange rates can have a significant impact on the reported results of our operations, which are presented in U.S. dollars. Year-over-year changes in sales, expenses and net income for 2011 compared with 2010 and 2010 compared with 2009, are presented both with and without the effects of foreign currency translation. Changes in sales, expenses and net income excluding foreign exchange effects are calculated using current year sales, expenses and net income translated at prior year exchange rates. Presenting changes in sales, expenses and net income excluding the effects of foreign currency translation is not in conformity with U.S. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“U.S. GAAP”), but we analyze this data because it is useful to us in understanding the operating performance of our business. We believe this data is also useful to shareholders for the same reason. The changes in sales, expenses and net income excluding the effects of foreign exchange translation are not meant to be a substitute for measurements prepared in conformity with U.S. GAAP, nor to be considered in isolation. Management believes that presenting these non-U.S. GAAP financial measures is useful to shareholders because it enhances their understanding of how management assesses the operating performance of the Company's business.

26

Table of Contents

Results of Operations for 2011 Compared with 2010

  
 
Year ended
December 31,
 
 
 
Excluding Foreign
Exchange Translation
(amounts in millions)
2011
 
2010
 
% change
reported  
 
2011 adjusted
amount  
 
% change
adjusted  
Sales
$
2,794.1

 
$
2,175.7

 
28.4
 %
 
$
2,661.3

 
22.3
 %
Cost of sales
1,986.1

 
1,560.6

 
27.3
 %
 
1,888.0

 
21.0
 %
Gross profit
808.0

 
615.1

 
31.4
 %
 
773.3

 
25.7
 %
Operating expenses
438.1

 
397.5

 
10.2
 %
 
419.3

 
5.5
 %
Operating income
369.9

 
217.6

 
70.0
 %
 
354.0

 
62.7
 %
Equity in net income of unconsolidated joint ventures
16.5

 
9.9

 
66.7
 %
 
16.4

 
65.7
 %
Other non-operating income / (expense), net
20.2

 
(402.6
)
 
*

 
27.8

 
*

Interest (expense), net
(1.7
)
 
(2.2
)
 
(22.7
)%
 
(1.7
)
 
(22.7
)%
Income / (loss) before income taxes
404.9

 
(177.3
)
 
*

 
396.5

 
*

Income tax expense
36.7

 
36.9

 
(0.5
)%
 
35.9

 
(2.7
)%
Net income / (loss) including noncontrolling interests
368.2

 
(214.2
)
 
*

 
360.6

 
*

Less: net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
11.2

 
11.9

 
(5.9
)%
 
11.5

 
(3.4
)%
Net income / (loss)
$
357.0

 
$
(226.1
)
 
*

 
$
349.1

 
*

* Percentage change not considered meaningful
Sales
Our sales for 2011 were $2.8 billion , an increase of 28.4% ( 22.3% excluding foreign currency translation effects) from $2.2 billion in 2010. The increase was attributable to the higher levels of commercial vehicle production that was evident in most regions across the world, expansion of our aftermarket and car businesses, as well as increased WABCO content per vehicle on trucks, buses and trailers globally. Total sales in Europe, our largest market, increased approximately 31.8% (24.5% excluding foreign currency translation effects) for the full year 2011. Total sales increased 42.5% in North America. Total sales in Asia increased 13.2% (9.4% excluding foreign currency translation effects). The sales growth in Asia included an increase in total sales in India of 14.7% (16.8% excluding foreign currency translation effects) and an increase in total sales in China of 1.5% (a decrease of 2.8% excluding foreign currency translation effects), which was impacted by the anticipated decline in production of new trucks and buses in China. Total sales in South America increased 27.7% (20.9% excluding foreign currency translation effects). Based on our analysis, we estimate that WABCO's sales growth for 2011 has outperformed the aggregate global market. The global aftermarket sales increase, included in the geographic numbers provided above, was 13.2% (8.0% excluding foreign currency translation effects), resulting in record aftermarket revenues. This performance demonstrates the continued success of the Company's aftermarket strategies initiated several years ago.
Gross Profit
Gross profit increased by $192.9 million ($158.2 million excluding foreign currency translation effects). Volume and mix contributed $99.8 million of the increase while our continued focus on materials and conversion productivity as well as the benefits realized from overhead absorption generated $104.3 million in improvements. The achievement of these levels of improvement include 5.9% savings on our conversion costs, a record amount, and 5.3% of materials savings before the cost of raw material inflation, which had a negative impact of 2.0% compared to last year. Partially offsetting these improvements were sales price declines that had a negative impact of $26.6 million, or 1.0% of sales. Labor and other cost escalations, net of changes in streamlining expenses, were higher by approximately $12.0 million. Foreign currency transactional impacts negatively affected gross profit in the amount of $7.3 million.
Operating Expenses
Operating expenses, which include selling and administrative expenses, product engineering expenses and other operating expenses, increased by $40.6 million ($21.8 million excluding foreign currency translation effects). The increase was mainly driven by new research and development investments of $14.9 million, investments in global expansion of $5.8 million, labor and other cost inflation of $7.0 million, partially offset by separation and other costs of $5.9 million.
Equity in Net Income of Unconsolidated Joint Ventures
Equity in net income of unconsolidated joint ventures increased $6.6 million to $16.5 million in 2011 as compared to

27


$9.9 million in 2010. The increase was primarily driven by income from the Meritor WABCO joint venture, which increased by $5.8 million. This increase is due to the fact that Meritor WABCO was able to benefit from more favorable market conditions in North America in 2011.
Other Non-Operating Expense, net
In 2010 we incurred an expense for the EC Fine indemnification in the amount of $400.4 million, driving the majority of the other non-operating expense incurred last year of $402.6 million . Absent this expense in 2011, our other non-operating income, net was $20.2 million . This amount is primarily made up of the reversal of approximately $23.1 million of indemnification liabilities due to the closing of a tax audit and other settlements.
Interest Expense, net
Net interest expense decreased by $0.5 million to $1.7 million of expense in 2011 compared to $2.2 million of expense in 2010. The overall change in net interest expense is the net impact from changing interest rates on our debt and investments, fees and credit margins and changes in outstanding balances associated with our Accounts Receivable Securitization Program and our $400 million revolving credit facility, which we refer to as our "revolving credit facility".
Income Taxes

The income tax provision for 2011 was $36.7 million on $404.9 million of pre-tax income before adjusting for noncontrolling interest, compared with $36.9 million on a pre-tax loss of $177.3 million before adjusting for noncontrolling interest in 2010. The tax charge for 2011 is the net result of taxes on earnings in profitable jurisdictions offset by fully valued net operating losses, the accrual of interest on uncertain tax positions and benefits from certain foreign tax planning. Furthermore, income tax expense is partially offset by the release of tax accruals of approximately $19.2 million as a consequence of the settlement of foreign tax audits and the expiration of a statute of limitation. Additionally, the Company provided a tax provision of $12.7 million during the fourth quarter due to the Company's decision to repatriate earnings from a foreign affiliate of approximately $299 million. The Company will recognize $13.6 million of tax benefits in the first quarter of 2012 due to certain government filings submitted in January 2012.
Net Income Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests decreased by $0.7 million ($0.4 million excluding foreign currency translation effects) to $11.2 million in 2011. The decrease is the result of the decline in earnings from our majority owned subsidiary in China that provides conventional mechanical products to the local market. This was partially offset by improved results of our WABCO India business as well as our U.S. partnership, WABCO Compressor Manufacturing.
Backlog
Backlog, which represents valid sales orders that have not yet been filled as of the end of the reporting period, was $1.1 billion at the end of the fourth quarter, up 10.2 % (up 13.3% excluding foreign currency translation effects) from the end of the fourth quarter of 2010 attributable to a significant uptick in production in the commercial vehicle industry. Backlog is not necessarily predictive of future business as it relates only to some of our products, and customers may still change future delivery dates.

28


Results of Operations for 2010 Compared with 2009
  
 
Year ended
December 31,
 
 
 
Excluding Foreign
Exchange Translation
(amounts in millions)
2010    
 
2009
 
% change
reported  
 
2010 adjusted
amount  
 
% change
adjusted  
Sales
$
2,175.7

 
$
1,491.5

 
45.9
%
 
$
2,196.1

 
47.2
%
Cost of sales
1,560.6

 
1,163.7

 
34.1
%
 
1,569.4

 
34.9
%
Gross profit
615.1

 
327.8

 
87.6
%
 
626.7

 
91.2
%
Operating expenses
397.5

 
342.7

 
16.0
%
 
407.4

 
18.9
%
Operating income / (loss)
217.6

 
(14.9
)
 
*

 
219.3

 
*

Equity in net income of unconsolidated joint ventures
9.9

 
3.1

 
*

 
10.0

 
*

Other non-operating (expense) / income, net
(402.6
)
 
24.5

 
*

 
(464.3
)
 
*

Interest (expense) / income, net
(2.2
)
 
0.5

 
*

 
(2.3
)
 
*

(Loss) / income before income taxes
(177.3
)
 
13.2

 
*

 
(237.3
)
 
*

Income tax expense / (benefit)
36.9

 
(10.7
)
 
*

 
33.2

 
*

Net (loss) / income including noncontrolling interests
(214.2
)
 
23.9

 
*

 
(270.5
)
 
*

Less: net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
11.9

 
5.1

 
*

 
11.5

 
*

Net (loss) / income
$
(226.1
)
 
$
18.8

 
*

 
$
(282.0
)
 
*

* Percentage change not considered meaningful
Sales
Our sales for 2010 were $2.2 billion, an increase of 45.9% (47.3% excluding foreign currency translation effects and 43.6% excluding the acquisition of WABCO India which the Company began consolidating in June of 2009) from $1.5 billion in 2009. The increase was attributable to the higher levels of commercial vehicle production that was evident in all markets across the world, expansion of our aftermarket business, as well as increased WABCO content per vehicle. Total sales in Europe, our largest market, increased approximately 35.9% (40.5% excluding foreign currency translation effects) for the full year 2010. Total sales increased 39.0% in North America. Total sales in Asia increased 80.5% (74.5% excluding foreign currency translation effects). The sales growth in Asia included an increase in total sales in China of 69.1% (67.4% excluding foreign currency translation effects), which continued to benefit from higher production levels in addition to increased content per vehicle. Total sales in South America increased 73.0% (56.1% excluding foreign currency translation effects), which benefited from increased production of T&B and growing content per vehicle. Based on our analysis, WABCO's sales growth for 2010 has outperformed the market growth in each region. The global aftermarket sales increase, included in the geographic numbers provided above, was 21.2% (22.3% excluding foreign currency translation effects). The sales for 2010 were at a record level for the aftermarket business, which has benefited from higher fleet utilization rates compared to 2009 and from the continued execution of our aftermarket growth strategies initiated several years ago.
Gross Profit
Gross profit increased by $287.3 million ($298.9 million excluding foreign currency translation effects). The main drivers of the increase in gross profit were volume and mix, materials and conversion productivity, and overhead absorption. Volume and mix contributed $142.2 million of the increase while our continued focus on materials and conversion productivity, as well as the benefits realized from overhead absorption generated $136.9 million in improvements. The achievement of this level of improvement was driven by our ability to maintain strict control over indirect costs and was accomplished in an environment where commodity inflation increased our materials cost by approximately 1.7% compared to last year. We generated $15.0 million in margin improvements by benefiting from the exchange rate advantages of our global manufacturing footprint. Also, included in gross profit was approximately $1.6 million of higher foreign currency transactional gains primarily related to the remeasurement of foreign currency monetary assets and liabilities on our balance sheet. Lower streamlining expenses increased gross profit by $36.5 million. Partially offsetting these improvements were sales price declines that had a negative impact of $29.8 million, or 1.3% of sales, and labor and other cost escalations of approximately $3.5 million.
Operating Expenses
Operating expenses, which include selling and administrative expenses, product engineering expenses and other

29


operating expenses, increased by $54.8 million ($64.7 million excluding foreign currency translation effects). Operational spending increased by $74.2 million which was comprised of the following components: the reinstatement of certain suspended costs including our annual incentive plan and elimination of reduced work weeks totaling $24.0 million, annual incentive plan expense accrued above our plan targets of $14.3 million, full year inclusion of India operating expenses and labor and other cost inflation and escalations of $12.4 million, and new investments of $23.5 million. The above operational spending increase of $74.2 million as well as increased separation costs of $8.7 million were partially offset by reduced costs associated with streamlining programs of $18.2 million.
Streamlining Expenses
We incurred $3.2 million of net streamlining expenses during 2010 of which $4.0 million was charged to cost of sales and $0.8 million was realized as net operating income. The total charge of $3.2 million is made up of $4.1 million of employee related costs and $1.3 million of net asset write-off's, partially offset by a reversal of $2.2 million relating to an employee benefit accrual true-up. We incurred $56.8 million of streamlining expenses during 2009 of which $19.8 million was charged to selling and administrative expenses and $37.0 million was charged to cost of sales. We expended $28.9 million of cash on streamlining activities in 2010.
Equity in Net Income of Unconsolidated Joint Ventures
Equity in net income of unconsolidated joint ventures increased $6.8 million to $9.9 million in 2010 as compared to $3.1 million in 2009. The increase was driven by income from the Meritor WABCO joint venture. This increase is due to the fact that Meritor WABCO was able to benefit from more favorable market conditions in North America in 2010.
Other Non-Operating Expense, net
Other non-operating expense, net increased by $427.1 million for 2010 as compared to 2009. This increase is primarily due to the payment of the EC fine in the amount of €326.1 million ($400.4 million at June 23, 2010 exchange rates) compared with the reversal of approximately $41.3 million of indemnification and other settlements in the statement of income in 2009 due to the closing of a tax audit and other settlements as well as a recorded gain on the sale of the investment in SCL of $0.7 million which was partially offset by a remeasurement loss of $11.5 million of our investment in WABCO-TVS recorded prior to the acquisition of WABCO-TVS.
Interest (Expense) / Income, net
Net interest (expense) / income decreased by $2.7 million ($2.8 million excluding foreign currency translation effects) to $2.2 million of expense in 2010 compared to $0.5 million of income in 2009. The overall change in net interest (expense) / income is the net impact from changing interest rates on our debt and investments, fees associated with our Accounts Receivable Securitization Program and the overall change in the net debt position attributable to the payment of the EC fine in the latter part of the third quarter of 2010.
Income Taxes
The income tax provision for 2010 was $36.9 million on pre-tax loss of ($177.3) million before adjusting for noncontrolling interest, compared with a benefit of $(10.7) million on $13.2 million of pre-tax income before adjusting for minority interest in 2009. The tax charge for 2010 is the result of taxes on earnings in profitable jurisdictions, the accrual of interest on uncertain tax positions and true-ups from filing income tax returns, partially offset by benefits from certain foreign tax planning and releases of accruals for uncertain tax positions for which the statute of limitations in foreign jurisdictions has expired. Additionally, the 2010 provision includes a valuation allowance for losses in certain foreign jurisdictions in which it is more likely than not that the losses will not be realizable in the foreseeable future. The tax provision for 2010 also excludes any benefit related to the payment of the EC fine. During the third quarter of 2010, an uncertain tax position of approximately $135.8 million was recorded at then foreign exchange rates for the tax deduction related to the payment of the EC fine. The WABCO entity that has claimed this deduction for $396.9 million has existing net operating losses in a foreign jurisdiction for which a full valuation allowance has been provided. Consequently, as this tax deduction would otherwise increase the deferred tax asset related to the net operating losses for which a full valuation allowance is provided, the uncertain tax position of $134.9 million at then foreign exchange rates is recorded as a reduction of the related deferred tax asset on the balance sheet.
Net Income Attributable to Noncontrolling Interests
Net income attributable to noncontrolling interests increased by $6.8 million ($6.4 million excluding foreign currency translation effects) to $11.9 million in 2010. The increase is primarily due to the improved results of WABCO India which the Company began consolidating in June of 2009.
Backlog
Backlog, which represents valid sales orders that have not yet been filled as of the end of the reporting period, was $1.0 billion at the end of the fourth quarter, up 61.1 % (up 67.9% excluding foreign currency translation effects) from the end of the

30


fourth quarter of 2009 attributable to a significant uptick in production in the commercial vehicle industry. Backlog is not necessarily predictive of future business as it relates only to some of our products, and customers may still change future delivery dates.

Liquidity and Capital Resources
We employ several means to manage our liquidity, and we are not dependent upon any one source of funding. Our sources of financing include cash flows from operations, cash and cash equivalents, our revolving credit facility, our Accounts Receivable Securitization Program and the use of operating leases.
We believe the combination of expected cash flows, the revolving credit facility being committed until September 2016, and the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program maturing in September 2015 (subject to annual renewal) will provide us with the relevant medium term liquidity to support the Company's operations.
Also, the Company's financial standing provides us with access to a wide range of additional external financing instruments.
Specifically for 2012 we expect our consolidated cash flow to be in line with the Company's 2011 cash flow profile, and there are no known trends or uncertainties that are reasonably expected to have a material effect on the separate sources and uses of cash.

As of December 31, 2011 , $99.7 million of the $102.4 million of cash and cash equivalents on the consolidated balance sheet was held by foreign subsidiaries, confirming our focus and intent to use our cash outside the U.S. The Company considers the earnings of substantially all of its foreign subsidiaries to be permanently reinvested outside the U.S. and as such no additional U.S. tax cost has been provided. The Company has provided for tax at the U.S. tax rate for its Brazilian affiliate's current year earnings in 2011. The Company estimates the amount of its unremitted foreign earnings permanently reinvested outside the U.S. to be approximately $250 million as December 31, 2011, however, it is not practicable to estimate the tax liability that would arise if the earnings that are considered permanently reinvested were remitted to the U.S.

During the fourth quarter, we decided to repatriate earnings from a foreign affiliate of approximately $299 million that were previously determined to be permanently reinvested outside of the U.S., in order to take advantage of a unique opportunity from the impact of the EC fine on its pool of foreign earnings. Irrespective of the repatriation, our current and projected U.S. cash inflows are sufficient to meet our U.S. obligations. The Company continues to assert permanent reinvestment outside the U.S. with respect to the remainder of its foreign earnings and the Company does not have any plans or needs to repatriate additional earnings from its foreign subsidiaries except for Brazil.

Cash Flows for 2011 Compared with 2010
Net cash provided by operating activities was $332.0 million for 2011 compared with net cash used by operating activities of $190.0 million for 2010.
We recorded net income including noncontrolling interests of $368.2 million for 2011 compared with net loss including noncontrolling interests of $214.2 million for 2010. The EC Fine indemnification incurred in 2010 in the amount of $400.4 million was the largest driver for this net loss. Net income for 2011 included noncash elements such as depreciation and amortization of $78.2 million , as well as an indemnification liability reversal of $23.1 million . Our working capital increased as a result of an increase in business activity. The increase was primarily driven by increased levels of accounts receivable mostly in the first half of the year and which could not be offset by the decrease at the end of the year. Inventory also increased however to a lower extent due to continuous efforts to bring the levels down. In addition to these, there was a decrease in accounts payable due to timing of payments at year end.
The change in other accrued liabilities and taxes was a decrease of $4.4 million for 2011 compared to an increase of $51.0 million for 2010. The major drivers of this change were net tax related items (value added tax, tax on income, tax indemnities), payment of bonuses under our annual incentive plan partially offset by an increase in local bonuses and freight accruals. The change in other current and long-term assets for 2011 was an increase of $34.8 million compared to an increase of $101.7 million for 2010. The main drivers of this change were an increase in notes receivables from our Chinese operation and net tax related items (value added tax, tax receivable on income), partially offset by a decrease of restricted cash related to the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program. The change in other long-term liabilities for 2011 was an increase of $8.6 million compared to a decrease of $40.1 million for 2010. The main drivers were an increase in tax contingencies partially offset by reclassification of a portion of streamlining costs to current liabilities.
The net cash used in investing activities amounted to $105.2 million in 2011 compared to net cash used in investing

31


activities of $70.7 million in 2010. The net cash usage for 2011 includes capital expenditures of $40.1 million of investments in tooling, $58.2 million on plant and equipment and $6.9 million in computer software, which supported our market growth and new programs in 2011. This compared with $29.2 million of investments in tooling, $36.5 million on plant and equipment and $8.0 million in computer software partially offset by $3.0 million of cash proceeds relating to the sale of a facility during 2010.
The net cash used by financing activities during 2011 amounted to $183.5 million compared to net cash used by financing activities of $15.4 million during 2010.
As of December 31, 2011 , our total third party debt was $78.2 million consisting primarily of $52.0 million of long-term debt borrowed under our $400 million five-year revolving credit facility. During 2011, we repaid approximately $46.6 million of debt outstanding at December 31, 2010 on our revolving credit facility. Also, subsidiaries in other countries had borrowings from banks totaling $26.2 million classified as short term debt. The increase in net borrowings of short-term debt from the prior year of $10.4 million is driven by a $24.4 million loan under a short term borrowing with Société Générale Bank Nederland N.V. related to the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program.
We received $36.6 million of stock option proceeds during 2011 compared with $41.8 million in 2010. The number of stock options exercised in 2011 and 2010 were 1,630,838 and 2,231,178 , respectively.
The Company's Board of Directors has approved a $400 million program to purchase shares of the Company's common stock in the open market. During 2011, we repurchased $180.5 million of shares of which $1.7 million was not settled until after December 31, 2011 . Future purchases of shares will be primarily funded via the Facility. At December 31, 2011 , we had the authority to make an additional $219.5 million of share repurchases. Between January 1, 2012 and February 16, 2012, we have repurchased an additional 427,894 shares for a total of $ 22.5 million .

Cash Flows for 2010 Compared with 2009
Net cash used by operating activities was $190.0 million for 2010. This is compared with net cash provided by operating activities of $146.4 million for 2009.
We recorded a net loss including noncontrolling interests of $214.2 million for 2010 compared with net income including noncontrolling interests of $23.9 million for 2009. The net loss for 2010 included noncash elements such as depreciation and amortization of $83.3 million. The cash flows also included payment of the EC fine of €326.1 million (or $400 million). While in 2009 our working capital decreased due to a reduction in business volume, during 2010, despite the recovery in the commercial vehicle industry, our working capital decreased again. The decrease in working capital was primarily driven by increased levels of accounts payable, partially offset by increased levels of inventory. During 2010, we sold accounts receivable under our Accounts Receivable Securitization Program. As of December 31, 2010, the amount of receivables sold and outstanding was $111.4 million which generated incremental cash and cash equivalents of $59.6 million and restricted cash of $51.8 million which remained with Société Générale Bank Nederland N.V. Additionally, our past due accounts receivable amounts continued to decrease and inventory turns increased during the period.
The change in other accrued liabilities and taxes was an increase of $51.0 million for 2010 compared to a decrease of $33.3 million for 2009. The major drivers of this change were indemnification and other tax related items as well as payroll items including the reinstatement of our annual incentive plan, partially offset by a reduction in our streamlining accruals. The change in other current and long-term assets for 2010 was an increase of $101.7 million compared to a decrease of $10.1 million for 2009. The main driver of this change was $51.8 million of restricted cash as a result of the sale of accounts receivables into the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program. The remaining amounts driving the change consisted mainly of increases in value added tax items, guaranteed notes, deposits and advances to suppliers.
The net cash used in investing activities amounted to $70.7 million in 2010 compared to net cash used in investing activities of $73.8 million in 2009. The net cash usage for 2010 included capital expenditures of $29.2 million of investments in tooling, $36.5 million on plant and equipment and $8.0 million in computer software partially offset by $3.0 million of cash proceeds relating to the sale of a facility. This compared with $32.4 million of investments in tooling, $26.9 million on plant and equipment, $7.4 million of net cash outlay for the WABCO-TVS acquisition and sale of SCL and $7.1 million in computer software during 2009.
The net cash used by financing activities during 2010 amounted to $15.4 million compared to $121.9 million of net cash used during 2009.
As of December 31, 2010, our total third party debt was $113.5 million consisting primarily of $96.6 million of long term debt borrowed under our $800 million five-year credit facility which is further discussed below under 'Credit Facility'. Also, subsidiaries in other countries had borrowings from banks totaling $16.9 million, of which $16.7 million was classified as short

32


term debt and $0.2 million as long term debt. The increase from prior year is driven by a $16.0 million loan under a short term borrowing with Société Générale Bank Nederland N.V. related to the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program. The remaining $0.9 million supported local working capital requirements.
We received $41.8 million of stock option proceeds during 2010 compared with $0.3 million in 2009. The number of stock options exercised in 2010 and 2009 were 2,231,178 and 38,621, respectively.
Credit Facility

On July 8, 2011 , we entered into a $400 million multi-currency five -year senior unsecured revolving credit facility with the lenders and agent banks party thereto, including Banc of America Securities Limited as agent, issuing bank and swingline lender, and Banc of America Securities Limited, Citigroup Global Markets Limited, Fortis Bank S.A./N.V., ING Belgium SA/NV, Société Générale Corporate & Investment Banking, The Bank of Tokyo-Mitsubishi UFJ, Ltd and The Royal Bank of Scotland NV, (Belgium) Branch, as mandated lead arrangers and bookrunners and Credit Lyonnais and Unicredit Bank AG as lead arrangers.

As of December 31, 2011 , this is our principal bank credit facility, and it expires on September 1, 2016 . It replaced our prior $800 million multi-currency five -year senior unsecured revolving credit facility.

Under the revolving credit facility, we may borrow, on a revolving basis, loans in an aggregate principal amount at any one time outstanding not in excess of $400 million . Up to $50 million under this facility may be used for issuing letters of credit, of which $ 48.7 million was unused as of December 31, 2011 , and up to $50 million is available in the form of swingline loans, all $ 50.0 million of which was available for use as of December 31, 2011 . At December 31, 2011 , the carrying amount of this facility approximated fair value. The balance outstanding on this facility as of December 31, 2011 , was $ 52.0 million in addition to $ 1.3 million of letters of credit. We have the intent and ability to carry its balance outstanding for at least a continuous twelve month period as of December 31, 2011 .
 
The proceeds of the borrowings under the revolving credit facility may be used to repurchase WABCO shares, finance acquisitions, refinance existing indebtedness and meet general financing requirements.

Interest on loans under the revolving credit facility is calculated at a rate per annum equal to an applicable margin which can vary from 0.80% to 1.55% based on the Company's leverage ratio plus LIBOR for loans denominated in U.S. Dollars, EURIBOR for loans denominated in Euros, HIBOR for loans denominated in Hong Kong Dollars and SIBOR for loans denominated in Singapore Dollars, plus mandatory costs, if any.

The applicable margins used to determine the LIBOR loan rate are determined based upon the Company's leverage ratio, which represents the ratio of our consolidated net indebtedness on the last day of any fiscal quarter to consolidated adjusted EBITDA (earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization adjusted for certain items) for the period of four consecutive fiscal quarters ending on such day. The revolving credit facility also provides for certain of the borrowers to pay various fees including a participation fee on the amount of the lenders' commitments thereunder.

The revolving credit facility contains terms and provisions (including representations, covenants and conditions) customary for credit agreements of this type. Our primary financial covenant is a leverage test which requires net indebtedness not to exceed three times adjusted four quarter trailing EBITDA. Additional financial covenants include an interest coverage test and a maximum subsidiary indebtedness test. The interest coverage test requires three times interest expense not to exceed adjusted four quarter trailing EBITDA. The maximum subsidiary indebtedness test limits the total aggregate amount of indebtedness of WABCO's subsidiaries, excluding indebtedness under the revolving credit facility, to $400 million , of which not more than $150 million may be secured. Financial covenants are not subject to any future changes in U.S. GAAP accounting standards and all cash on the balance sheet can be deducted for net indebtedness purposes. In addition, expenses and payments related to any streamlining of WABCO’s operations are excluded when calculating the four quarter trailing adjusted EBITDA. Other covenants include delivery of financial reports and other information, compliance with laws including environmental laws and permits, ERISA and U.S. regulations, limitations on liens, mergers and sales of assets and change of business. At December 31, 2011 we had the ability to borrow an incremental $ 346.7 million under our revolving credit facility and we were in compliance with all the covenants.
As of December 31, 2011 , the Company's various subsidiaries had borrowings from banks totaling $ 26.2 million , of which $ 24.4 million relates to our Accounts Receivable Securitization Program. The remaining $ 1.8 million supports local working capital requirements.
Accounts Receivable Securitization Program & Financing Receivables

33


As discussed above, we have the ability to use our Accounts Receivable Securitization Program as one of several means to manage our liquidity.  Under the terms of the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program that we entered into with Société Générale Bank Nederland N.V. ("Société Générale") on September 23, 2009, we have the ability to sell our accounts receivable directly to Société Générale. The maximum funding from receivables that may be sold into the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program is €100 million; however, there can be no assurance that the Company will generate sufficient eligible receivables to access the maximum availability. The original term of the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program was for one year, with the possibility of four additional annual extensions, assuming the Company and the participating sellers are in compliance with the applicable covenants. The Company extended the Receivables Program in September 2011 for one additional year.
During the year ended December 31, 2011 , the Company sold all of its eligible receivables into the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program. The receivables were removed from the balance sheet in accordance with the guidance under ASC topic 860, Transfers and Servicing . The total amount of receivables sold under the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program during the year ended December 31, 2011 was € 816.8 million ($ 1,136.8 million at weighted average December 31, 2011 year-to-date exchange rates). The amount of eligible receivables sold and outstanding at December 31, 2011 amounted to € 76.6 million ($ 99.3 million at December 31, 2011 exchange rates).
As a result of the sale, accounts receivable decreased by $ 99.3 million and cash and cash equivalents increased by $ 52.5 million . The remaining amount of proceeds of $ 46.8 million is a subordinated deposit, before cash collections with Société Générale at December 31, 2011 .
As a result of the Company's access to the cash collections of the sold receivables, the company collected $ 36.8 million of additional cash as of December 31, 2011 . Of these cash receipts, $ 24.4 million is classified on the consolidated balance sheet as loans payable to bank and $ 12.4 million reduced the subordinated deposit to $ 34.4 million which is classified as restricted cash on the consolidated balance sheet at December 31, 2011 .
Also, the Company has pledged unsold receivables under the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program of € 1.8 million ($ 2.3 million at December 31, 2011 exchange rates).
The fair value of the receivables sold equaled the carrying cost at time of sale, and no gain or loss was recorded as a result of the sale. The Company estimated the fair value of sold receivables using Level 3 inputs and based the estimate on historical and anticipated performance of similar receivables, including historical and anticipated credit losses (if any). As part of the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program, the Company continues to service the receivables. The Company sells the receivables at face value, but receives actual funding net of the subordinated deposit account until collections are received from customers for the receivables sold. The Company is exposed to the credit losses of sold receivables up to the amount of its subordinated deposit account at each settlement date. Credit losses for receivables sold and past due amounts outstanding at December 31, 2011 were both immaterial. Servicing fees paid for the program were $ 1.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 .
Other financing receivables include sales to reputable State Owned and Public Enterprises in China that are settled through notes receivable which are registered and endorsed to the Company. These notes receivable are fully secured and generally have contractual maturities of six months or less. These guaranteed notes are available to be discounted with banking institutions in China or transferred to suppliers to settle liabilities. The total amount of notes receivable discounted or transferred for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 were $ 62.8 million and $ 85.3 million , respectively, resulting in expenses of $ 0.6 million and $ 0.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, which are included in “Other non-operating expense, net.” The carrying amounts of these guaranteed notes receivable are $ 40.0 million and $ 22.4 million as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, and are included in “other current assets” on the consolidated balance sheets. The Company monitors the credit quality of these notes through historical losses and current economic conditions with Chinese banks. As these receivables are guaranteed by banks and the Company has not experienced any historical losses nor is the Company expecting future credit losses, we have not established a loss provision against these receivables as of December 31, 2011 or December 31, 2010.

Factoring Program
On April 15, 2009, we entered into a €35 million factoring program, which has a term of five years, in respect to accounts receivable from one of our customers. To date, we have not utilized this program.

Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities
We recognize all derivative financial instruments in the consolidated balance sheet at fair value using Level 2 inputs

34


and these are classified as “other current assets,” “other assets,” “other accrued liabilities” or “other liabilities” on the consolidated balance sheet. Level 2 inputs used by the Company in valuing its derivative instruments include model-based valuation techniques for which all significant assumptions are observable in the market. The earnings impact resulting from changes in the fair value of derivative instruments is recorded in the same line item in the consolidated statement of operations as the underlying exposure being hedged or in accumulated other comprehensive income ("AOCI") for derivatives that qualify and have been designated as cash flow hedges or hedges of a net investment in a foreign operation. Any ineffective portion of a financial instrument's change in fair value is recognized in earnings together with changes in the fair value of any derivatives not designated as relationship hedges.
 
Foreign exchange contracts are used by us to offset the earnings impact relating to the variability in exchange rates on certain monetary assets and liabilities denominated in non-functional currencies and have not been designated as relationship hedges. As of December 31, 2011 , forward contracts for an aggregate notional amount of € 205.1 million ($ 265.9 million at December 31, 2011 exchange rates) were outstanding with an average duration of one month. The fair value of derivative assets at December 31, 2011 is $1.1 million and the fair value of derivative liabilities at December 31, 2011 is $1.5 million .
  

For the year ended December 31, 2011 , we recognized a net gain on our derivative instruments of $0.2 million , of which $1.5 million expense is recognized in "cost of sales" and $1.7 million income is recognized in "other non-operating expense, net" on the consolidated statement of operations. As the Company did not enter into derivative contracts during 2010, no gain or loss was recorded.
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements
    Please see the disclosure above in “Accounts Receivable Securitization Program.”
Contractual Obligations
Following is a summary of contractual obligations as of December 31, 2011 .
Aggregate Contractual Obligations
As of December 31, 2011
(in millions)
 
Payments due by period(1)  
Contractual Obligation  
 
Total  
 
2012
 
2013 and 2014  
 
2015 and 2016
 
Beyond 2016  
Debt obligations (principal plus interest)(2)
 
$
80.8

 
$
26.8

 
$
1.1

 
$
52.9

 
$

Operating lease obligations(3)
 
68.8

 
18.0

 
23.7

 
15.5

 
11.6

Tax indemnifications(4)
 
14.4

 
11.2

 

 

 

Purchase obligations(5)
 
152.9

 
152.9

 

 

 

Unfunded pension and post-retirement benefits(6)
 
288.9

 
28.0

 
57.4

 
57.9

 
145.6

Tax liabilities(7)
 
71.9

 
4.9

 

 

 

Total
 
$
677.7

 
$
241.8

 
$
82.2

 
$
126.3

 
$
157.2



(1)
The amounts and timing of such obligations, as shown in the table may vary substantially from amounts that will actually be paid in future years. For example, the actual amount to be paid under debt obligations under our revolving credit facility will depend on the amount of debt outstanding under the agreement in each year.
(2)
Amounts shown for debt obligations include the associated interest amounting to $2.6 million, calculated at the December 31, 2011 rates applicable to each type of debt.
(3)
Amounts include future rental commitments under all non-cancelable operating leases in effect at December 31, 2011.
(4)
Amounts are estimated costs that the Company is responsible for under a Tax Sharing Agreement between Trane and WABCO. The remaining $3.2 million is classified as long term and the Company is currently unable to estimate the timing of the potential amounts to be paid beyond 2012.
(5)
In the normal course of business we expect to purchase approximately $1.3 billion in 2012 of materials and services, and estimate that on average no more than approximately $152.9 million is outstanding at any one time in the form of legally binding commitments. We spent approximately $1.7 billion, $1.3 billion and $0.9 billion on materials and services in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
(6)
Amounts represent undiscounted projected benefit payments to WABCO's unfunded plans over the next ten years, as well

35


as expected contributions to funded pension plans for 2012. The expected benefit payments are estimated based on the same assumptions used to measure our accumulated benefit obligation at the end of 2011 and include benefits attributable to estimated future employee service of current employees.
(7)
Amounts represent the Company's unrecognized tax benefits (including interest of $4.6 million ) potentially owed to tax authorities as described in Note 15 - Income Taxes. The remaining $67.0 million liability is classified as long term and the Company is currently unable to estimate the timing of potential amounts to be paid beyond 2012.

Capital Expenditures
We believe our capital spending in recent years has been sufficient to maintain efficient production capacity, to implement important product and process redesigns and to expand capacity to meet increased demand. Productivity projects have freed up capacity in our manufacturing facilities and are expected to continue to do so. We expect to continue investing to expand and modernize our existing facilities and invest in our facilities to create capacity for new product development.
Pending Adoptions of Recently Issued Accounting Standards
We do not expect the pending adoption of recently issued accounting standards to have an impact on the consolidated financial statements.
Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates
Our discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations are based upon our consolidated financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles. The preparation of financial statements in conformity with those accounting principles requires us to make judgments and estimates that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes. Those judgments and estimates have a significant effect on the consolidated financial statements because they result primarily from the need to make estimates about the effects of matters that are inherently uncertain. Actual results could differ from those estimates. We frequently re-evaluate our judgments and estimates that are based upon historical experience and on various other assumptions that we believe to be reasonable under the circumstances.
We believe that of our significant accounting policies (see Note 2 of Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements), the ones that may involve a higher degree of uncertainty, judgment and complexity are allowance for doubtful accounts, inventory reserves, facilities, goodwill, stock-based compensation, post-retirement benefits, warranties, income taxes, and contingencies.

Allowance for Doubtful Accounts -The Company performs ongoing credit evaluations of its customers. In determining the allowance for doubtful accounts, on a monthly basis, WABCO analyzes the aging of accounts receivable, historical bad debts, customer creditworthiness, availability of credit insurance and current economic trends. Though management considers the valuation of the allowances proper and adequate, changes in the economy and/or deterioration of the financial condition of the Company's customers could affect the reserve balances required. Historically, this valuation has proved to be a reasonable estimate of the Company's experience with doubtful debts.
    
Inventory Reserves - On a quarterly basis, the Company tests its inventory for slow moving and obsolete stock by considering both the historical and expected sales and the Company will record a provision, if needed. Historically, this policy has given a close approximation of the Company's experience with slow moving and obsolete inventory. From time to time unusual buying patterns or shifts in demand may cause large movements in the reserve.
Property, Plant & Equipment -Property, plant and equipment balances are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation. WABCO capitalizes costs, including interest during construction of fixed asset additions, improvements, and betterments that add to productive capacity or extend the asset life. WABCO assesses facilities for impairment when events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of these assets may not be recoverable. Maintenance and repair expenditures are expensed as incurred.
Goodwill -The Company has a significant amount of goodwill on its balance sheet that is not amortized, but subject to impairment tests each fiscal year on October 1 st or more often when events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of goodwill may not be recoverable. The Company's impairment tests utilize the two-step approach. The first step of the goodwill impairment test compares fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is not considered impaired and thus the second step of the impairment test is unnecessary. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step of the goodwill impairment test shall be performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. The second step of the goodwill impairment test compares the implied fair value of reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill.

36


If the carrying amount of reporting unit goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss shall be recognized in an amount equal to that excess.
The recoverability of goodwill is measured based on one reporting unit for the total Company. WABCO's plants, engineering, technical support, distribution centers and other support functions are shared among various product families and serve all distribution channels with many customers. Based on the organizational structure, as well as the nature of financial information available and reviewed by the Company's chief operating decision maker to assess performance and make decisions about resource allocations, the Company has concluded that its total WABCO operations represent one reportable unit and that WABCO's performance and future net cash flow perspectives are best understood and assessed as such. In order to approximate the fair value of the reporting unit for purposes of testing recoverability, we use the total market capitalization of the Company, a market approach, which is then compared to the total book value of the Company. In the event the Company's fair value has fallen below book value, the Company will compare the estimated fair value of goodwill to its book value. If the book value of goodwill exceeds the estimated fair value of goodwill, the Company will recognize the difference as an impairment loss in operating income. There has been no impairment of goodwill during 2011, and the Company's goodwill was not at risk for failing the first step of its impairment test.
Stock-Based Compensation -The Company measures and recognizes in its combined statement of income the expense associated with all share-based payment awards made to employees and directors including stock options, restricted stock units and restricted stock grants based on estimated fair values. The Company utilizes the Black-Scholes option valuation model to measure the amount of compensation expense to be recognized for each option award. There are several assumptions that must be made when using the Black-Scholes model such as the expected term of each option, the expected volatility of the stock price during the expected term of the option, the expected dividends to be paid and the risk free interest rate expected during the option term. The risk free interest rate is based on the yield of U.S. Treasury securities that correspond to the expected holding period of the options. WABCO reviewed the historic volatility of its common stock over a four year period, the common stock of its peer group over a five year period, and the implied volatility for at the money options to purchase shares of its common stock. The five year historical volatility period was selected since that period corresponds with the expected holding period. Based on this data, the Company chose to use a weighted average of the implied volatility of WABCO, the most recent four year historical volatility of WABCO and the median most recent one year historical volatility of WABCO's peer group prior to the spin-off date. The expected holding period was calculated by reviewing the historical exercise pattern of all holders that were granted options and the exercise behavior of officers versus non-officers. The results of the analysis support one expected holding period for all groups of employees. The expected forfeiture rate was determined based on the historical stock option forfeiture data of the Company. The dividend yield was based on an expected future dividend rate for the period at the time of grant. Of these assumptions, the expected term of the option and expected volatility of WABCO's common stock are the most difficult to estimate since they are based on the exercise behavior of employees and expected performance of WABCO's stock. An increase in the volatility of WABCO's stock will increase the amount of compensation expense on new awards. An increase in the holding period of options will also cause an increase in compensation expense. Dividend yields and risk-free interest rates are less difficult to estimate. An increase in the dividend yield will cause a decrease in expense and an increase in the risk-free interest rate will increase compensation expense. Assumptions used for volatility, expected holding period and forfeiture rate were updated by the Company as of September 1, 2011 and will be used for grants in the following 12 months.
Post-Retirement Benefits - The Company has significant pension and post-retirement benefit costs and liabilities that are developed from actuarial valuations. Inherent in these valuations are key assumptions including discount rates, expected return on plan assets, mortality rates, merit and promotion increases and the health care cost trend rate. The Company is required to consider current market conditions, including changes in interest rates and health care costs, in making its assumptions. Changes in the related pension and post-retirement benefit costs or liabilities may occur in the future due to changes in the assumptions. The assumptions as to the expected long-term rates of return on plan assets are based upon the composition of plan assets, historical long-term rates of return on similar assets and current and expected market conditions. The discount rate used for U.S. plans reflects the market rate for high-quality fixed-income investments on the Company's annual measurement date (December 31) and is subject to change each year. The discount rate was determined by matching, on an approximate basis, the coupons and maturities for a portfolio of corporate bonds (rated Aa or better by Moody's Investor Services) to the expected plan benefit payments defined by the projected benefit obligation. The discount rates used for plans outside the U.S. are based on a combination of relevant indices regarding corporate and government securities, the duration of the liability and appropriate judgment. A decrease of one percentage point in the assumed rate of return on plan assets and a decrease of one percentage point in the discount rate applied to projected benefit obligations would increase annual pension expense by approximately $ 0.9 million . An increase of one percentage point in the assumed health care cost trend rate in each future year would increase annual health insurance costs by approximately $ 0.9 million . The impact of Health Care Reform legislation in the U.S. is immaterial to WABCO. See the disclosures about pension and post-retirement obligations, the composition of plan assets, assumptions and other matters in Note 12 of Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

37


Warranties - Products sold by WABCO are covered by a basic limited warranty with terms and conditions that vary depending upon the product and country in which it was sold. The limited warranty covers the equipment, parts and labor (in certain cases) necessary to satisfy the warranty obligation generally for a period of two years. Estimated product warranty expenses are accrued in cost of goods sold at the time the related sale is recognized. Estimates of warranty expenses are based primarily on warranty claims experience and specific customer contracts. Warranty expenses include accruals for basic warranties for product sold, as well as accruals for product recalls, service campaigns and other related events when they are known and estimable.
To the extent we experience changes in warranty claim activity or costs associated with servicing those claims, our warranty accrual is adjusted accordingly. Warranty accrual estimates are updated based upon the most current warranty claims information available. The Company's warranty costs as a percentage of net sales totaled 1.5% in 2011, 1.5% in 2010 and 1.6% in 2009. We do not expect this percentage to change in the near future. See Note 14 of Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements for a three-year summary of warranty costs.
Income taxes -We record a valuation allowance to reduce our deferred tax assets to the amount that we believe is more likely than not to be realized. While we have considered future taxable income and ongoing prudent and feasible tax planning strategies in assessing the need for the valuation allowance, in the event we were to determine that we would not be able to realize all or part of our net deferred tax assets in the future, an adjustment to decrease the net deferred tax assets would be charged to income in the period such determination was made. Likewise, should we determine that we would be able to realize our deferred tax assets in the future in excess of our net recorded amount, an adjustment to increase the net deferred tax assets would increase income in the period such determination was made. Deferred tax assets have been reduced by a valuation allowance of $130.4 million at December 31, 2011 foreign exchange rates related to foreign net operating losses.
We also estimate our effective income tax rate periodically, considering all known factors and the estimated effects of future events or tax planning strategies that can cause that rate to vary from the statutory rate. Estimating the outcome of future events is inherently uncertain and final resolution of those events can cause the effective rate to vary significantly. In addition, changes in U.S. or foreign tax laws or rulings may have a significant impact on our effective tax rate.
A tax position is a position in a previously filed tax return or a position expected to be taken in a future tax filing that is reflected in measuring current or deferred income tax assets and liabilities. Tax positions shall be recognized only when it is more likely than not (likelihood of greater than 50%), based on technical merits, that the position will be sustained. Tax positions that meet the more likely than not threshold should be measured using a probability weighted approach as the largest amount of tax benefit that is greater than 50% likely of being realized upon settlement. Whether the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold is met for a tax position, is a matter of judgment based on the individual facts and circumstances of that position evaluated in light of all available evidence. Tax positions are not permitted to be recognized, derecognized, or remeasured due to changes subsequent to the balance sheet date, but prior to the issuance of the financial statements. Rather, these changes are recorded in the period the change occurs with appropriate disclosure of such subsequent events, if significant. The Company accrues interest and penalties related to unrecognized tax benefits in income tax expense.

In situations where the Company has tax deductions that would otherwise increase a deferred tax asset related to net operating losses for which a full valuation allowance is provided, a tax deduction which is treated as an uncertain tax position is recorded as a reduction of the deferred tax asset on the balance sheet. In this regard, although the uncertain tax position was not reflected as an unrecognized tax benefit in the balance sheet as a recorded liability, it is disclosed in the tabular rollforward for unrecognized tax benefits in the notes to the financial statements. As further discussed in Note 15 - Income Taxes, this applies to the unrecognized tax benefit of $142.4 million at December 31, 2011 foreign exchange rates for the indemnification payment for the EC fine of $396.9 million at then foreign exchange rates.

Contingencies -We are subject to proceedings, lawsuits and other claims related to products and other matters. We are required to assess the likelihood of any adverse judgments or outcomes to these matters as well as potential ranges of probable and reasonably possible losses. A determination of the amount of liability to be recorded, if any, for these contingencies is made after careful analysis of each individual issue. It is reasonably possible that the Company could incur losses in excess of the amounts accrued. Although this amount cannot be estimated, we believe that any additional losses would not have a material adverse impact on the consolidated financial statements.

In conjunction with the Tax Sharing Agreement, as further discussed in Note 16 - Tax and Indemnification Liabilities Transferred from Trane to WABCO, in Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements, WABCO is responsible for certain tax and indemnification liabilities. These liabilities include indemnification liabilities to Trane of $9.6 million.

Cyclical and Seasonal Nature of Business

38



The industry in which we operate is cyclical. Approximately 73% of our sales are for newly manufactured trucks, buses and trailers, the production of which follows long investment cycles and are impacted by macro economic factors and legislation. Global commercial vehicle production has consistently been growing since 2001. In the fourth quarter of 2008, however, the global commercial vehicle markets started to experience a significant decline that was unprecedented in its breadth, depth and speed which continued through 2009. All markets experienced favorable growth in 2010 while our most developed markets again experienced favorable growth in 2011. Our markets are difficult to predict; however, in 2012 we are anticipating a decline in production from OEMs in Europe, South America and China and increases from OEMs in North America, India, Japan and Korea versus levels in 2011. The continued adoption of new technologies by truck and bus manufacturers helps our business outperform the rate of truck and bus production over the longer term. The commercial vehicle industry is not subject to material seasonal impacts.

39



ITEM 7A.      QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
We are exposed to financial risk resulting from volatility in foreign currency exchange rates, interest rates and commodity prices. All of those risks are closely monitored.
Foreign Currency Exchange Rates
We conduct operations through controlled subsidiaries in most of the major countries of Western Europe, Brazil, Poland, China, South Korea, India and Japan as well as the US. In addition, we conduct business in many countries through cross border sales and purchases, affiliated companies and partnerships in which we own 50% or less of the stock or partnership interest. As our financial statements are presented in U.S. Dollars, fluctuations in currency exchange rates can have a significant impact on the reported results of our operations, especially for the countries and currencies referred to above. Applying a Value-At-Risk (“VAR”) methodology to our foreign currency exchange rate exposure, across the translational, cash flow and balance sheet exposures for the year 2011, the potential maximum loss in earnings is estimated to be $38 million which is based on a 1- year horizon and a 95 % confidence level. The VAR model is a risk analysis tool and does not purport to represent actual losses in fair value that could be incurred by us, nor does it consider the potential effect of favorable changes in market factors or our ability to pass on foreign exchange effects to commercial counterparties.
Interest Rate Sensitivity
All of the Company's financial debt and investments are based on floating rates. Even material moves of the interest rates, based on the weighted average of net outstanding interest bearing debt in 2011, would have an immaterial effect on our 2011 earnings.
Commodity Exposures
We are also exposed to fluctuations in commodity prices through the purchase of base metals and steel, mainly through contractual agreements with component suppliers.
Applying a VAR methodology to this exposure, the potential maximum loss in earnings is estimated to be $26 million which is based on a 1-year horizon and a 95 % confidence level. The VAR model is a risk analysis tool and does not purport to represent actual losses in fair value that could be incurred by us, nor does it consider the potential effect of favorable changes in market factors or our ability to pass on effects to commercial counterparties.

40

Table of Contents



Item 8.
Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

The Board of Directors and Shareholders of WABCO Holdings Inc.

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of WABCO Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations, shareholders' equity and comprehensive income / (loss), and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011.  Our audit also included the financial statement schedule listed in the Index at Item 15(a). These financial statements and schedule are the responsibility of the Company's management.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and schedule based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of WABCO Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries at December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the consolidated results of their operations and their cash flows for each the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles. Also, in our opinion, the related financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), WABCO Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries' internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated February 17, 2012 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

Ernst & Young Bedrijfsrevisoren BCVBA/Reviseurs d'Entreprises SCCRL


Represented by:
/s/ Harry Everaerts, Partner
Brussels, Belgium
February 17, 2012

41




WABCO HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
 
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions, except share and per share data)
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Sales
$
2,794.1

 
$
2,175.7

 
$
1,491.5

Cost of sales
1,986.1

 
1,560.6

 
1,163.7

Gross Profit
808.0

 
615.1

 
327.8

Costs and expenses:
 
 
 
 
 
Selling and administrative expenses
327.2

 
306.6

 
271.7

Product engineering expenses
105.1

 
85.9

 
75.2

Other operating expense / (income), net
5.8

 
5.0

 
(4.2
)
Operating income / (loss)
369.9

 
217.6

 
(14.9
)
European Commission fine indemnification

 
(400.4
)
 

Equity income of unconsolidated joint ventures, net
16.5

 
9.9

 
3.1

Other non-operating (expense), net
(2.9
)
 
(2.2
)
 
(5.3
)
Indemnification settlements, net
23.1

 

 
41.3

Fair value adjustment charge of the noncontrolling interest prior to taking control

 

 
(11.5
)
Interest (expense) / income, net
(1.7
)
 
(2.2
)
 
0.5

Income / (loss) before income taxes
404.9

 
(177.3
)
 
13.2

Income tax expense / (benefit)
36.7

 
36.9

 
(10.7
)
Net income / (loss) including noncontrolling interests
368.2

 
(214.2
)
 
23.9

Less: net income attributable to noncontrolling interests
11.2

 
11.9

 
5.1

Net income / (loss)
$
357.0

 
$
(226.1
)
 
$
18.8

Net income / (loss) per common share
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
$
5.35

 
$
(3.50
)
 
$
0.29

Diluted
$
5.19

 
$
(3.50
)
 
$
0.29

Cash dividends per share of common stock
$

 
$

 
$
0.07

Weighted average common shares outstanding
 
 
 
 
 
Basic
66,693,064

 
64,562,222

 
64,024,237

Diluted
68,829,440

 
64,562,222

 
65,030,557

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

42

Table of Contents

WABCO HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
 
December 31,
2011
 
December 31,
2010
(Amounts in millions, except share data)
 
 
 
ASSETS
 
 
 
Current assets:
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
102.4

 
$
67.1

Accounts receivable, less allowance for doubtful accounts of $3.4 in 2011 and $7.7 in 2010
296.3

 
265.9

Inventories
198.0

 
192.6

Taxes receivable on income
18.5

 
7.6

Future income tax benefits
8.7

 
7.3

Restricted cash
34.4

 
51.8

Guaranteed notes receivable
40.0

 
22.4

Other current assets
52.4

 
43.0

Total current assets
750.7

 
657.7

Property, plant and equipment, less accumulated depreciation
357.4

 
350.3

Goodwill
363.9

 
378.4

Long-term future income tax benefits
58.8

 
57.9

Investments in unconsolidated joint ventures
16.5

 
14.4

Intangible assets, net
35.6

 
40.1

Other assets
40.3

 
26.1

TOTAL ASSETS
$
1,623.2

 
$
1,524.9

LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
 
 
 
Current liabilities:
 
 
 
Loans payable to banks
$
26.2

 
$
16.7

Accounts payable
137.8

 
158.4

Accrued payroll
108.1

 
103.0

Current portion of warranties
42.3

 
41.7

Indemnification liabilities
11.2

 
33.1

Income tax liabilities
4.9

 
29.0

Other accrued liabilities
121.1

 
118.6

Total current liabilities
451.6

 
500.5

Long-term debt
52.0

 
96.8

Post-retirement benefits
348.6

 
344.1

Deferred tax liabilities
25.8

 
26.7

Long-term income tax liabilities
67.0

 
53.0

Other liabilities
42.4

 
43.8

Total liabilities
987.4

 
1,064.9

Commitments and contingencies

 

Shareholders’ equity:
 
 
 
Preferred stock, 4,000,000 shares authorized; none issued and outstanding

 

Common stock, $.01 par value, 400,000,000 shares authorized; shares issued: 74,242,930 in 2011; 72,415,415 in 2010; and shares outstanding: 64,765,655 in 2011; 66,458,609 in 2010
0.7

 
0.7

Capital surplus
693.4

 
646.4

Treasury stock, at cost: 9,477,275 shares in 2011; 5,956,806 shares in 2010
(456.8
)
 
(276.3
)
Retained earnings
416.6

 
59.6

Accumulated other comprehensive income:
 
 
 
Foreign currency translation adjustments
(16.1
)
 
33.0

Unrealized losses on benefit plans, net of tax
(50.6
)
 
(51.1
)
Total shareholders’ equity
587.2

 
412.3

Noncontrolling interests
48.6

 
47.7

Total equity
635.8

 
460.0

TOTAL LIABILITIES AND EQUITY
1,623.2

 
1,524.9


See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

43

Table of Contents

WABCO HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS  
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions)
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net income / (loss) including noncontrolling interests
$
368.2

 
$
(214.2
)
 
$
23.9

Adjustments to reconcile net income / (loss) to net cash provided / (used) by operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Depreciation
66.4

 
66.3

 
69.0

Amortization of intangibles
11.8

 
17.0

 
20.6

Fair value adjustment of the noncontrolling interest prior to taking control

 

 
11.5

Equity in earnings of unconsolidated joint ventures, net of dividends received
(2.1
)
 
(1.5
)
 
3.1

Non-cash stock compensation
13.7

 
13.0

 
12.7

Deferred income tax benefit
1.9

 
(2.6
)
 
(21.0
)
Loss on sale or disposal of property, plant and equipment
1.1

 
7.4

 
2.5

Gain on divestitures

 

 
0.8

Indemnification settlements, net
(23.1
)
 

 
(41.3
)
Changes in assets and liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
Accounts receivable, net
(40.1
)
 
(3.8
)
 
68.3

Inventories
(14.8
)
 
(41.8
)
 
23.0

Accounts payable
(18.1
)
 
50.3

 
(13.1
)
Other accrued liabilities and taxes
(4.4
)
 
51.0

 
(33.3
)
Post - retirement benefits
(2.3
)
 
10.7

 
(5.4
)
Other current and long-term assets
(34.8
)
 
(101.7
)
 
10.1

Other long-term liabilities
8.6

 
(40.1
)
 
15.0

Net cash provided / (used) by operating activities
332.0

 
(190.0
)
 
146.4

Investing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Purchases of property, plant and equipment
(98.3
)
 
(65.7
)
 
(59.3
)
Investments in capitalized software
(6.9
)
 
(8.0
)
 
(7.1
)
       Proceeds from the disposal of property, plant and equipment

 
3.0

 

       Divestitures, net

 

 
(7.4
)
Net cash used in investing activities
(105.2
)
 
(70.7
)
 
(73.8
)
Financing activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net (repayments) / borrowings of revolving credit facilities
(46.6
)
 
(66.4
)
 
121.0

Borrowings of long-term debt

 

 
0.8

Repayments of long-term debt
(0.2
)
 
(0.4
)
 
(161.9
)
Net borrowings / (repayments) of short-term debt
10.4

 
13.9

 
(74.2
)
Purchases of treasury stock
(178.9
)
 

 

Dividend payments

 

 
(4.5
)
Dividends to noncontrolling interest holders
(4.8
)
 
(4.3
)
 
(3.4
)
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
36.6

 
41.8

 
0.3

Net cash used in financing activities
(183.5
)
 
(15.4
)
 
(121.9
)
Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents
(8.0
)
 
(7.0
)
 
6.7

Net increase / (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents
35.3

 
(283.1
)
 
(42.6
)
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period
67.1

 
350.2

 
392.8

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period
$
102.4

 
$
67.1

 
$
350.2

Cash paid during the period for:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest
$
1.1

 
$
1.9

 
2.9

Income taxes
$
54.1

 
$
47.9

 
3.4

Non cash items for the period:
 
 
 
 
 
Treasury stock purchase accrual
$
1.7

 
$

 


44

Table of Contents

See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

45

Table of Contents

WABCO HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF SHAREHOLDERS' EQUITY AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME / (LOSS)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income
 
 
 
 
(Amounts in millions)
Common
Stock
 
Capital
Surplus
 
Treasury
Stock
 
Retained
Earnings
 
Foreign
Currency
Translation
Effects
 
Unrealized
Losses on
Benefit Plans,
net of tax
 
Noncontrolling Interests
 
Comprehensive
Income / (Loss)
Balance at December 31, 2008
$
0.7

 
$
578.4

 
$
(276.3
)
 
$
271.4

 
$
51.4

 
$
(24.1
)
 
$
13.4

 
 
Net income

 

 

 
18.8

 

 

 
5.1

 
23.9

Foreign currency translation

 

 

 

 
37.0

 
2.0

 
0.6

 
39.6

Unrealized gains on pension, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 
(27.8
)
 

 
(27.8
)
Total comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
$
35.7

Changes in ownership of noncontrolling interests

 

 

 

 

 

 
23.1

 
 
Stock options exercised

 
0.5

 

 

 

 

 

 
 
Stock-based compensation

 
12.8

 

 

 

 

 

 
 
Other stock issued

 
(0.2
)
 

 

 

 

 

 
 
Dividends paid

 

 

 
(4.5
)
 

 

 
(3.4
)
 
 
Balance at December 31, 2009
$
0.7

 
$
591.5

 
$
(276.3
)
 
$
285.7

 
$
88.4

 
$
(49.9
)
 
$
38.8

 
 
Net income

 

 

 
(226.1
)
 

 

 
11.9

 
(214.2
)
Foreign currency translation

 

 

 

 
(55.4
)
 
1.8

 
1.5

 
(52.1
)
Unrealized gains on pension, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 
(3.0
)
 

 
(3.0
)
Total comprehensive loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
$
(269.3
)
Stock options exercised

 
41.8

 

 

 

 

 

 
 
Stock-based compensation

 
13.0

 

 

 

 

 

 
 
Other stock issued

 
0.1

 

 

 

 

 

 
 
Dividends paid

 

 

 

 

 

 
(4.3
)
 
 
Balance at December 31, 2010
$
0.7

 
$
646.4

 
$
(276.3
)
 
$
59.6

 
$
33.0

 
$
(51.1
)
 
$
47.9

 
 
Net income

 

 

 
357.0

 

 

 
11.2

 
368.2

Foreign currency translation

 

 

 

 
(49.1
)
 
0.4

 
(5.7
)
 
(54.4
)
Unrealized losses on pension, net of tax

 

 

 

 

 
0.1

 

 
0.1

Total comprehensive loss
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
313.9

Treasury stock purchased

 

 
(180.5
)
 

 

 

 

 
 
Stock options exercised

 
36.6

 

 

 

 

 

 
 
Stock-based compensation

 
10.4

 

 

 

 

 

 
 
Dividends paid

 

 

 

 

 

 
(4.8
)
 
 
Balance at December 31, 2011
$
0.7

 
$
693.4

 
$
(456.8
)
 
$
416.6

 
$
(16.1
)
 
$
(50.6
)
 
$
48.6

 
 
See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

46

Table of Contents


WABCO HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
NOTES TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
December 31, 2011

NOTE 1.
Description of Company
WABCO Holdings Inc. and its subsidiaries (collectively “WABCO” or the “Company”) develops, manufactures and sells advanced braking, stability, suspension and transmission control systems primarily for commercial vehicles. WABCO’s largest selling products are pneumatic anti-lock braking systems (“ABS”), electronic braking systems (“EBS”), automated manual transmission systems, air disk brakes and a large variety of conventional mechanical products such as actuators, air compressors and air control valves for heavy and medium-sized trucks, trailers and buses. We also supply advanced electronic suspension controls and vacuum pumps to the car and SUV markets in Europe, North America and Asia. In addition, we sell replacement parts, diagnostic tools, training, remanufacturing and other services to commercial vehicle aftermarket distributors, repair shops, and fleet operators. WABCO sells its products to four groups of customers around the world: truck and bus original equipment manufacturers (“OEMs”), trailer OEMs, aftermarket distributors of replacement parts and services and automotive OEMs.

WABCO was founded in the United States in 1869 as Westinghouse Air Brake Company. The Company was purchased by American Standard Companies Inc. (or “American Standard”) in 1968 and operated as the Vehicle Control Systems business division within American Standard until the Company was spun off from American Standard on July 31, 2007. Subsequent to the spin-off, American Standard changed its name to Trane Inc., which is herein referred to as “Trane.” On June 5, 2008, Trane was acquired in a merger with Ingersoll-Rand Company Limited (“Ingersoll Rand”) and exists today as a wholly owned subsidiary of Ingersoll-Rand.

The spin-off by Trane of its Vehicle Control Systems business became effective on July 31, 2007, through a distribution of 100% of the common stock of WABCO to Trane's shareholders (the “Distribution”). The Distribution was effected through a separation and distribution agreement pursuant to which Trane distributed all of the shares of WABCO common stock as a dividend on Trane common stock, in the amount of one share of WABCO common stock for every three shares of outstanding Trane common stock to each shareholder on the record date. Trane received a private letter ruling from the Internal Revenue Service and an opinion from tax counsel indicating that the spin-off was tax free to the shareholders of Trane and WABCO.
Based on the organizational structure, as well as the nature of financial information available and reviewed by the Company’s chief operating decision maker to assess performance and make decisions about resource allocations, the Company has concluded that its total WABCO operations represent one reportable segment and that WABCO’s performance and future net cash flow perspectives are best understood and assessed as such. For purposes of cash flow presentation, the Company has presented both cash flow activities for the revolving credit facilities and short-term debt on a net presentation basis as these items represent cash flow activities where turnover is quick, the amounts are large and the maturities are short. Although maturities are short-term for the revolving credit facilities, we have the intent and ability to continue to refinance the debt on a long-term basis until maturity in 2016.

NOTE 2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies
Use of Estimates -The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements and accompanying notes. Management believes the most complex and sensitive judgments, because of their significance to the condensed consolidated financial statements, result primarily from the need to make estimates about the effects of matters that are inherently uncertain. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Some of the most significant estimates included in the preparation of the consolidated financial statements are related to allowance for doubtful accounts, inventory reserves, facilities, goodwill, warranties, post-retirement benefits, income taxes and stock-based compensation. Allocation methods are described in the notes to these consolidated financial statements where appropriate.
Principles of Consolidation and Presentation -All majority owned or controlled subsidiaries of WABCO are included in the consolidated financial statements and intercompany transactions are eliminated upon consolidation. WABCO investments in unconsolidated joint ventures are included at cost plus its equity in undistributed earnings in accordance with the equity method of accounting and reflected as investments in unconsolidated joint ventures in the consolidated balance sheet. Certain amounts in the prior years' consolidated financial statements have been reclassified to conform to the current year presentation.

47


Foreign Currency Translation -Adjustments resulting from translating foreign functional currency assets and liabilities into U.S. dollars are recorded in a separate component of shareholders' equity. Gains or losses resulting from transactions in other than the functional currency are reflected in the consolidated statement of income, except for intercompany transactions of a long-term investment nature.
Revenue Recognition -Sales of products are recorded (i) upon shipment if title passes to the customer upon shipment, or upon delivery if title passes to the customer upon delivery, (ii) when persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists with the customer, (iii) when the sales price is fixed and determinable, and (iv) when the collectability of the sales price is reasonably assured. Amounts billed to customers for shipping and handling costs are included in sales.
WABCO typically records cooperative advertising allowances, rebates and other forms of sales incentives as a reduction of sales at the later of the date of the sale or the date the incentive is offered. For these costs, WABCO recorded $ 43.0 million , $ 33.9 million and $ 26.9 million in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively, in the accompanying consolidated statements of income.
In most countries where WABCO operates, sales are subject to VAT taxes. Sales are presented net of VAT in the consolidated statements of income.
Shipping and Handling Costs -Shipping, handling, receiving, inspecting, warehousing, internal transfer, procurement and other costs of distribution are included in cost of sales in the consolidated statements of income.
Cash and Cash Equivalents -Cash equivalents include all highly liquid investments with maturity of three months or less when purchased. The Company classifies cash and cash equivalents that are restricted from operating use for the next twelve months as restricted cash. Amounts restricted for longer than twelve months are classified as other assets. When restrictions are no longer in place, the amounts are reclassified to cash and cash equivalents.
Allowance for Doubtful Accounts - The Company performs ongoing credit evaluations on its customers. In determining the allowance for doubtful accounts, on a monthly basis, WABCO analyzes the aging of accounts receivable, historical bad debts, customer creditworthiness, availability of credit insurance and current economic trends.

Transfers of Financial Instruments- The Company accounts for sales and transfers of financial instruments under Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 860. ASC 860 states that a transfer of financial assets (either all or a portion of a financial asset) in which the transferor surrenders control over those financial assets shall be accounted for as a sale to the extent that consideration other than beneficial interests in the transferred assets is received in exchange. The Company sells receivables to the bank which qualify as financial assets since they are associated with the sale of products by the subsidiaries of the Company and accepted by the Company's customers in the ordinary course of business. For all receivables sold to the bank, the risks of collection of such receivables reside with the bank. Therefore, upon sale of the receivables to the bank, the appropriate reversal of any applicable accounts receivable allowances are recorded by the Company.

Inventory Reserves - Inventory costs are determined by the use of the last-in, first-out (LIFO) method, and are stated at the lower of such cost or realizable value. The LIFO method is used as it provides a better matching of the costs to the sales. Inventories are categorized as finished products, products-in-process and raw materials. On a quarterly basis, the company tests its inventory for slow moving and obsolete stock by considering both the historical and expected sales and the Company will record a provision, if needed.
Property, Plant & Equipment -Property, plant and equipment balances are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation. WABCO capitalizes costs, including interest during construction of fixed asset additions, improvements, and betterments that add to productive capacity or extend the asset life. WABCO assesses facilities for impairment when events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of these assets may not be recoverable. Maintenance and repair expenditures are expensed as incurred.
 
Depreciation -Depreciation and amortization are computed on the straight-line method based on the estimated useful life of the asset or asset group, which are 40 years for buildings, 3 years for tooling and 5 to 15 years for machinery and equipment.
Computer Software Costs -WABCO capitalizes the costs of obtaining or developing internal-use computer software, including directly related payroll costs. WABCO amortizes those costs on a straight-line basis over periods up to seven years, beginning when the software is ready for its intended use. WABCO assesses capitalized software costs for impairment when events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of these assets may not be recoverable.
Goodwill -The Company has a significant amount of goodwill on its balance sheet that is not amortized, but subject to impairment tests each fiscal year on October 1 st or more often when events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of goodwill may not be recoverable. The Company's impairment tests utilize the two-step approach. The first step of the

48


goodwill impairment test compares fair value of a reporting unit with its carrying amount, including goodwill. If the fair value of a reporting unit exceeds its carrying amount, goodwill of the reporting unit is not considered impaired and thus the second step of the impairment test is unnecessary. If the carrying amount of a reporting unit exceeds its fair value, the second step of the goodwill impairment test shall be performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. The second step of the goodwill impairment test compares the implied fair value of reporting unit goodwill with the carrying amount of that goodwill. If the carrying amount of reporting unit goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss shall be recognized in an amount equal to that excess.
The recoverability of goodwill is measured based on one reporting unit for the total Company. WABCO's plants, engineering, technical support, distribution centers and other support functions are shared among various product families and serve all distribution channels with many customers. Based on the organizational structure, as well as the nature of financial information available and reviewed by the Company's chief operating decision maker to assess performance and make decisions about resource allocations, the Company has concluded that its total WABCO operations represent one reportable segment and that WABCO's performance and future net cash flow perspectives are best understood and assessed as such. In order to approximate the fair value of the reporting unit for purposes of testing recoverability, we use the total market capitalization of the Company, a market approach, which is then compared to the total book value of the Company. In the event the Company's fair value has fallen below book value, the Company will compare the estimated fair value of goodwill to its book value. If the book value of goodwill exceeds the estimated fair value of goodwill, the Company will recognize the difference as an impairment loss in operating income. There has been no impairment of goodwill during 2011.
Other Intangible Assets with Determinable Lives -Other intangible assets with determinable lives consist of customer and distribution relationships, patented and unpatented technology, in-process research and development, and other intangibles and are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives, ranging from 1 to 15 years. WABCO assesses intangible assets for impairment when events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of these assets may not be recoverable.
Debt Issuance Costs -The costs related to the issuance of debt are capitalized and amortized over the life of the related debt. The Company has a balance of $3.1 million related to deferred financing costs included in other assets as of December 31, 2011 . A total of $0.5 million was amortized during the year ended December 31, 2011 and included in selling and administrative expenses.
Warranties -Products sold by WABCO are covered by a basic limited warranty with terms and conditions that vary depending upon the product and country in which it was sold. The limited warranty covers the equipment, parts and labor (in certain cases) necessary to satisfy the warranty obligation generally for a period of two years. Estimated product warranty expenses are accrued in cost of good sold at the time the related sale is recognized. Estimates of warranty expenses are based primarily on warranty claims experience and specific customer contracts. Warranty expenses include accruals for basic warranties for product sold, as well as accruals for product recalls, service campaigns and other related events when they are known and estimable. To the extent WABCO experiences changes in warranty claim activity or costs associated with servicing those claims, its warranty accrual is adjusted accordingly. Warranty accrual estimates are updated based upon the most current warranty claims information available. The Company's warranty costs as a percentage of net sales totaled 1.5% in 2011, 1.5% in 2010 and 1.6% in 2009. See Note 13 for a summary of warranties.
Post-retirement Benefits -All post-retirement benefits are accounted for on an accrual basis using actuarial assumptions. Post-retirement pension benefits are provided for substantially all employees of WABCO, both in the U.S. and abroad through plans specific to each of WABCO's legal entities. In addition, in the U.S., certain employees receive post-retirement health care and life insurance benefits. The impact of Health Care Reform legislation in the U.S. is immaterial to the Company. The costs of the benefits provided through plans of WABCO are included in the accompanying consolidated financial statements and summarized in detail along with other information pertaining to these plans in Note 11. Plans are primarily concentrated in the United Kingdom, Austria, Germany, and Switzerland.
WABCO is also required to measure a defined benefit post-retirement plan's assets and obligations that determine its funded status as of the end of the employer's fiscal year, and recognize changes in the funded status of a defined benefit post-retirement plan in comprehensive income in the year in which the changes occur.
Fair Value of Financial Instruments -Financial instruments consist mainly of cash, accounts receivable, accounts payable, loans payable to banks and long-term debt. At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the carrying amounts of these instruments approximated their fair values.
Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities -The Company recognizes all derivative financial instruments in the consolidated financial statements at fair value. Changes in the fair value of derivative financial instrument which qualify for hedge accounting are recorded as an offset to the changes in fair value of the underlying hedged item and are included in the account other non-operating expense, net or other operating expense, net. See Note 19 for further details on derivative

49


instruments.
Research, Development and Engineering Expenses -Research and development costs are expensed as incurred. WABCO expended approximately $ 105.1 million in 2011, $ 85.9 million in 2010 and $ 75.2 million in 2009 for research activities, product development and for product engineering.
Income Taxes -Deferred income taxes are determined on the liability method, and are recognized for all temporary differences between the tax basis of assets and liabilities and their reported amounts in the consolidated financial statements. No provision is made for U.S. income taxes applicable to undistributed earnings of foreign subsidiaries that are indefinitely reinvested.
A tax position is a position in a previously filed tax return or a position expected to be taken in a future tax filing that is reflected in measuring current or deferred income tax assets and liabilities. Tax positions are recognized only when it is more likely than not (likelihood of greater than 50% ) based on technical merits, that the position will be sustained upon examination. Tax positions that meet the more likely than not threshold are measured using a probability weighted approach as the largest amount of tax benefit that is greater than 50% likely of being realized upon settlement. Tax positions are not permitted to be recognized, derecognized, or remeasured due to changes subsequent to the balance sheet date, but prior to the issuance of the financial statements. Rather, these changes are recorded in the period the change occurs with appropriate disclosure of such subsequent events, if significant.

In situations where the Company has tax deductions that would otherwise increase a deferred tax asset related to net operating losses, for which a full valuation allowance is provided, a tax deduction which is treated as an uncertain tax position is recorded as a reduction of the deferred tax asset on the balance sheet. In this regard, although the uncertain tax position was not reflected as an unrecognized tax benefit in the balance sheet as a recorded liability, it is disclosed in the tabular rollforward for unrecognized tax benefits in the notes to the financial statements. As further discussed in Note 15 - Income Taxes, this applies to the unrecognized tax benefit of $ 142.4 million at December 31, 2011 exchange rates for the payment for the EC fine of $ 396.9 million at then exchange rates.
Earnings Per Share- Basic net income / (loss) per share has been computed using the weighted average number of WABCO common shares outstanding. The average number of outstanding shares of common stock used in computing diluted net income / (loss) per share includes weighted average incremental shares when the impact is not anti-dilutive. The weighted average incremental shares represent the net amount of shares the Company would issue upon the assumed exercise of in-the-money stock options and vesting of restricted stock units (“RSUs”) after assuming that the Company would use the proceeds from the exercise of options to repurchase treasury stock. Anti-dilutive options are excluded and represent those options whose exercise price was greater than the average price of the Company's common stock. The average number of outstanding shares of common stock used in computing diluted net income / (loss) per share included no weighted average incremental shares for the year ended December 31, 2010 since the impact would be anti-dilutive.

 
Year Ended December 31,
 
2011
2010
2009
Weighted average incremental shares included
2,136,376


1,006,320

Shares excluded due to anti-dilutive effect
205,321


2,964,029


Comprehensive Income / (Loss) -Comprehensive income / (loss) consists of net income, foreign currency translation adjustments and pension liability adjustments and unrecognized gains or losses on post-retirement benefit plans and is presented in the accompanying consolidated statement of shareholders' equity and comprehensive income.
Stock-Based Compensation -WABCO measures and recognizes in its combined statement of income the expense associated with all share-based payment awards made to employees and directors including stock options, restricted stock units and restricted stock grants based on estimated fair values.
All options granted prior to 2007 were adjusted upon the Distribution into two separate options, one relating to the Company's common stock and one relating to Trane common stock. This adjustment was made such that immediately following the Distribution (i) the number of shares relating to the Company options were equal to the number of shares of Company common stock that the option holder would have received in the Distribution had Trane options represented outstanding shares of Trane common stock, and (ii) the per share option exercise price of the original Trane stock option was proportionally allocated between the two types of stock options based upon the relative per share trading prices of the Company and Trane immediately following the Distribution. Thus, upon the Distribution, WABCO options are being held by both

50


WABCO and Trane employees and Trane options continued to be held by WABCO employees. Options granted to WABCO employees in 2007 were equitably adjusted upon Distribution so as to relate solely to shares of the Company's common stock. These adjustments preserved the economic value of the awards immediately prior to the Distribution. All Company options issued as part of this adjustment and the Trane options are fully vested at this time. Further, for purposes of vesting and the post-termination exercise periods applicable to such stock options, the Trane Inc. Management Development and Compensation Committee determined that continued employment with the Company will be viewed as continued employment with the issuer of the options.
WABCO uses the Black-Scholes option valuation model to measure the amount of compensation expense to be recognized for each option award. Outstanding WABCO options held by non-WABCO employees or directors arose as a result of the Distribution and are not reflected in compensation expense recognized by the Company. Consequently, these stock options do not result in any tax benefits to the Company at any time. The WABCO options held by non-employees or directors are considered in the Company's diluted EPS calculation.


NOTE 3.
Recently Issued Accounting Standards
The adoption of recently issued accounting standards did not have any impact on the consolidated financial statements, nor do we expect the pending adoption of recently issued accounting standards to have an impact on the consolidated financial statements.

Note 4.
Streamlining Expenses
The Company accounts for employee-related streamlining charges as either a one-time benefit arrangement or an ongoing benefit arrangement as appropriate. From time to time the Company also has streamlining charges that are not related to employees, such as facility exit costs.
Based on market declines occurring in the fourth quarter of 2008, we commenced a streamlining program on October 28, 2008 (the “2008/2009 Program”), which began with a consultative process with works councils and employee representatives globally. The 2008/2009 Program reduced our global workforce by approximately 1,800 employees. This level of reduction in workforce brought our capacity in line with market demand, while still allowing us to continue our focus on core strategies, including technology, new products, globalization, and quality and productivity initiatives. We believe the completion of these actions created sufficient flexibility in production and helped us to cope with anticipated demand volatility. The Company does not expect to incur any further charges on the 2008/2009 Program.
Based on the Company’s efforts to maintain our global footprint, the Company will periodically enter into other streamlining programs as deemed necessary (“Other Programs”). No ongoing individual program is assessed as material, and the Company does not expect to incur significant additional charges for ongoing programs as of December 31, 2011 .
The following is a summary of changes in the Company’s streamlining program liabilities for the year ended December 31, 2011 (amounts in millions). Activity for the period consisted of termination payments and employee-related charges.  
2008 / 2009 Program
 
Balance as of December 31, 2010
$
30.0

Charges during 2011

Payments during 2011
(12.5
)
Balance as of December 31, 2011
$
17.5

Other Programs
 
Balance as of December 31, 2010
$
1.4

Charges during 2011
2.7

Payments during 2011
(1.8
)
Balance as of December 31, 2011
$
2.3

Foreign exchange translation effects
$

Total streamlining liability as of December 31, 2011
$
19.8

A balance of $ 11.4 million is included in other liabilities (non-current) and $ 8.4 million is included in other accrued

51


liabilities (current) as of December 31, 2011 .
The following is a summary of current and cumulative streamlining costs (including employee-related costs shown above as well as asset write-offs and other charges).
 
 
 
Charges for Year
Ended December 31, 2011
 
Cumulative Charges as
of December 31, 2011
 
 
2008/2009
Program
 
Other
Programs
 
2008/2009
Program
 
Other
Programs
Employee-related charges – cost of sales
 
$

 
$
2.1

 
$
45.7

 
$
4.8

Employee-related charges – selling and administrative
 

 
0.6

 
45.8

 
2.0

Total employee related charges
 


2.7

 
91.5

 
6.8

Asset (recoveries) / write-offs – cost of sales
 

 
(0.5
)
 

 
0.8

Total program costs
 
$

 
$
2.2

 
$
91.5

 
$
7.6


NOTE 5.
Capital Stock
The following is a summary of net shares outstanding and shares issued or reacquired during the years ending December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.  
 
Number of Shares of Common Stock
 
Total Shares
 
Treasury Shares
 
Net Shares
Outstanding
Balance, December 31, 2008
69,921,105

 
(5,956,806
)
 
63,964,299

       Shares issued upon exercise of stock options
38,621

 

 
38,621

       Shares issued upon vesting of RSUs
74,526

 

 
74,526

       Shares purchased for treasury

 

 

Balance, December 31, 2009
70,034,252

 
(5,956,806
)
 
64,077,446

       Shares issued upon exercise of stock options
2,231,178

 

 
2,231,178

       Shares issued upon vesting of RSUs
149,985

 

 
149,985

       Shares purchased for treasury

 

 

Balance, December 31, 2010
72,415,415

 
(5,956,806
)
 
66,458,609

Shares issued upon exercise of stock options
1,630,838

 

 
1,630,838

Shares issued upon vesting of RSUs
196,677

 

 
196,677

Shares purchased for treasury

 
(3,520,469
)
 
(3,520,469
)
Balance, December 31, 2011
74,242,930

 
(9,477,275
)
 
64,765,655

The Company accounts for purchases of treasury stock under the cost method with the costs of such share purchases reflected in treasury stock in the accompanying condensed consolidated balance sheets. When treasury shares are reissued, they are recorded at the average cost of the treasury shares acquired since the inception of the share buy back programs, net of shares previously reissued and the Company reflects the difference between the average cost paid and the amount received for the reissued shares in capital surplus. As of December 31, 2011 , no shares have been reissued.
The Company's Board of Directors has approved a program to purchase shares of the Company's common stock. The authorization by the Board of Directors on May 26, 2011 approved the purchase of shares in an amount not to exceed $ 400.0 million which expires on May 31, 2013. As of December 31, 2011 , the Company had repurchased a total of $ 180.5 million of shares leaving an unexpended balance of $ 219.5 million available to repurchase shares in the future. Between January 1, 2012 and February 16, 2012, the Company has repurchased an additional 427,894 shares for a total of $ 22.5 million . The Company plans to continue to purchase shares at prevailing market prices. Timing will vary depending on market conditions and other factors.

NOTE 6.
Stock-Based Compensation
The Company's Certificate of Incorporation authorizes the Company to issue up to 400,000,000 shares of common stock, par value $0.01 per share and 4,000,000 shares of preferred stock, par value $0.01 per share.


52


The Company paid dividends of $ 4.5 million in 2009 on our common stock. The Company paid no dividends in 2011 or 2010.
The WABCO Holdings Inc. 2007 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “2007 Omnibus Plan”), was formally adopted by our Board of Directors prior to the Distribution. The 2007 Omnibus Plan was replaced in May 2009 by the WABCO Holdings Inc. 2009 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “2009 Omnibus Plan”) which was approved by the shareholders at the Annual Meeting of Shareholders. The 2009 Omnibus plan is intended to promote our long-term financial success and increase shareholder value by providing us with the flexibility to implement annual and long-term cash, equity and equity-based incentives. The 2009 Omnibus Plan is also intended to align the interests of our employees with the interests of our shareholders by affording them certain opportunities to acquire an interest in our stock. We believe that these incentives and opportunities will encourage our executives and other key employees to continue in our employment, by providing them with a competitive level of compensation that varies based on our performance. Under the 2009 Omnibus Plan, the Company may issue the following types of awards: stock options, stock appreciation rights (sometimes referred to as SARs), restricted stock, restricted shares, annual incentive awards and long-term incentive awards. The maximum number of shares or units that may be issued under the 2009 Omnibus Plan is 5,100,000 . No participant shall be granted stock options, stock appreciation rights, or both with respect to more than 750,000 shares during any calendar year. No individual shall be granted restricted stock or restricted stock units, with respect to 200,000 shares or units as the case may be during any calendar year. If an award under either the 2007 Omnibus Plan or the 2009 Omnibus Plan expires or becomes unexercisable without having been exercised in full, or, with respect to full-value incentive awards, is forfeited to or repurchased by the Company, the unpurchased shares will become available for future grant or sale under the 2009 Omnibus Plan. At December 31, 2011 , options to purchase a total of 4,427,521 shares, RSUs and restricted shares were outstanding and there were 4,393,602 shares remaining available for grant under the 2009 Omnibus Plan.
The Company records stock-based compensation based on the estimated fair value of the award at the grant date and is recognized as an expense in the condensed consolidated statements of income over the requisite service period. Total stock-based compensation cost recognized during the years ended December 31, 2011 , 2010 and 2009 were as follows:
 
Year Ended December 31,
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Stock-based compensation (before tax effects)
$
13.7

 
$
13.0

 
$
12.7

The total number and type of awards granted during the periods presented and the related weighted-average grant-date fair values were as follows:

53


 
Shares underlying options
 
Weighted - Average Exercise Price
 
Weighted - Average Grant Date Fair Value
 
WABCO employees
 
Trane employees
 
Total
 
 
Options Outstanding December 31, 2008
1,512,860

 
2,843,077

 
4,355,937

 
$
32.53

 
 
Options Granted
3,123,932

 

 
3,123,932

 
$
11.77

 
$
2.77

Options Exercised
(5,711
)
 
(32,910
)
 
(38,621
)
 
$
14.35

 
 
Options Forfeited
(135,549
)
 
(39,166
)
 
(174,715
)
 
$
28.29

 
 
Options Outstanding December 31, 2009
4,495,532

 
2,771,001

 
7,266,533

 
$
23.78

 
 
Options Granted
564,848

 

 
564,848

 
$
27.49

 
$
9.80

Options Exercised
(859,444
)
 
(1,371,734
)
 
(2,231,178
)
 
$
18.75

 
 
Options Forfeited
(124,179
)
 
(134,234
)
 
(258,413
)
 
$
29.33

 
 
Options Outstanding December 31, 2010
4,076,757

 
1,265,033

 
5,341,790

 
$
26.02

 
 
Options Granted
276,287

 

 
276,287

 
$
59.24

 
$
22.94

Options Exercised
(1,228,475
)
 
(403,731
)
 
(1,632,206
)
 
$
22.52

 
 
Options Forfeited
(34,329
)
 
(8,865
)
 
(43,194
)
 
$
34.12

 
 
Options Outstanding December 31, 2011
3,090,240

 
852,437

 
3,942,677

 
$
29.61

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exercisable at December 31, 2011
1,326,010

 
852,437

 
2,178,447

 
33.73

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RSUs Outstanding December 31, 2008
161,799

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RSUs Granted
412,240

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
11.79

RSUs Vested
(60,319
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RSUs Forfeited
(9,991
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RSUs Outstanding December 31, 2009
503,729

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RSUs Granted
235,201

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
25.81

RSUs Vested
(190,706
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RSUs Forfeited
(24,831
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RSUs Outstanding December 31, 2010
523,393

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RSUs Granted
220,181

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
62.44

RSUs Vested
(245,035
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RSUs Forfeited
(13,695
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RSUs Outstanding December 31, 2011
484,844

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
In 2011 , a total of 276,287 options were granted of which all are exercisable in equal installments over a period of three years. In 2010 , a total of 564,848 options were granted of which all are exercisable in equal installments over a period of three years. In 2009, a total of 3,123,932 options were granted of which 3,068,035 are exercisable in equal annual installments over a period of three years. Of the remaining 55,897 options granted in 2009, 36,887 of the options become exercisable after two years and 19,010 become exercisable after three years. In 2011, a total of 220,181 RSUs were granted of which 101,647 vest ratably over a period of three years. Of the remaining 118,534 RSUs granted in 2011, 3,973 vest after two years, 41,064 vest after three years and 73,497 vest after four years. In 2010, a total of 235,201 RSUs were granted of which 225,523 vest ratably over a period of three years. Of the remaining 9,678 RSUs granted in 2010, 6,635 vest after two years and 3,318 vest after three years. All of the RSUs granted in 2009 vest ratably over a period of three years.
The total aggregate intrinsic value of awards outstanding as of December 31, 2011 is $ 63.1 million . The total aggregate intrinsic value of options exercisable as of December 31, 2011 is $ 18.5 million . The total aggregate intrinsic value of options outstanding, less expected forfeitures, as of December 31, 2011 is $ 44.5 million . Aggregate intrinsic value is calculated by subtracting the exercise price of the option from the closing price of the Company's common stock on December 31, 2011 , multiplied by the number of shares per each option. In addition, the weighted average remaining contractual life of options outstanding as of December 31, 2011 is 6.3 years and the weighted average remaining contractual life of options outstanding,

54


less expected forfeitures, as of December 31, 2011 is 6.2 years. The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the year ended December 31, 2011 was $ 68.9 million and the total fair value of shares vested during the same period was $ 13.2 million . The 1,764,230 of nonvested options and RSUs as of December 31, 2011 will result in the recognition of $ 19.3 million of compensation cost. This cost will be recognized over the weighted average period of 2.4 years. The weighted average remaining contractual life of the vested options as of December 31, 2011 is 5.0 years. The contractual life of all options is 10.0 years. The tax benefit from stock options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 was immaterial.
The weighted average grant date fair value was calculated under the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. The following table summarizes the significant assumptions used for the grants during the years ended December 31, 2011 , 2010 and 2009:
 
Year Ended December 31,
Assumption
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Risk-free interest rate
2.30
%
 
2.39
%
 
1.86
%
Expected volatility
42.82
%
 
40.96
%
 
31.60
%
Expected holding period
5 Years

 
5 Years

 
5 Years

Expected forfeiture rate
2.3
%
 
2.0
%
 
0.8
%
Expected dividend yield
0.47
%
 
1.02
%
 
2.45
%
The risk free interest rate is based on the yield of U.S. Treasury securities that correspond to the expected holding period of the options. WABCO reviewed the historic volatility of its common stock over a three -year period, the common stock of its peer group over a five -year period, and the implied volatility for at the money options to purchase shares of its common stock. The five-year historical volatility period was selected since that period corresponds with the expected holding period. Based on this data, the Company chose to use a weighted average of the implied volatility of WABCO, the most recent three-year historical volatility of WABCO and the median most recent two -year historical volatility of WABCO’s peer group prior to the spin-off date. The expected holding period was calculated by reviewing the historical exercise pattern of all holders that were granted options and the exercise behavior of officers versus non-officers. The results of the analysis support one expected holding period for all groups of employees. The expected forfeiture rate was determined based on the historical stock option forfeiture data of the Company. The dividend yield was based on an expected future dividend amount for the period at the time of grant. Assumptions used for volatility, expected holding period and forfeiture rate were updated by the Company as of September 1, 2011 and will be used for grants in the following 12 months. The new assumptions for volatility to be used for future grants is 44.48% , for expected holding period is 5 years and for forfeiture rate is 2.6% .

NOTE 7.
Other Operating and Non-Operating Expense / (Income), Net
Other expense / (income) was as follows:
 
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions)
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Operating:
 
 
 
 
 
Separation related taxes
$

 
$

 
$
(4.3
)
Bank charges
1.7

 
1.3

 

Miscellaneous taxes
1.8

 

 

Other, net
2.3

 
3.7

 
0.1

 
$
5.8

 
$
5.0

 
$
(4.2
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-operating:
 
 
 
 
 
Tax indemnification liabilities
$
0.3

 
$
1.0

 
$
3.0

Receivable discount fees
2.3

 
1.6

 
0.5

Losses on accounts receivable securitization program

 

 
0.8

Foreign exchange (gain) / loss
(0.6
)
 

 
1.2

Other, net
0.9

 
(0.4
)
 
(0.2
)
 
$
2.9

 
$
2.2

 
$
5.3



55


NOTE 8.
Inventories
The components of inventories, which are carried on a last-in, first-out (LIFO) basis, are as follows:
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions)
 
2011
 
2010
Finished products
$
82.4

 
$
80.7

Products in process
8.6

 
7.0

Raw materials
107.0

 
104.9

Inventories at cost
$
198.0

 
$
192.6

The current replacement cost approximated the LIFO carrying cost for 2011 and 2010.

NOTE 9.
Facilities
The components of facilities, at cost, are as follows:
 
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions)
 
2011
 
2010
Land
$
18.3

 
$
19.2

Buildings
153.0

 
160.4

Machinery and equipment
557.4

 
550.0

Improvements in progress
37.8

 
30.8

Gross facilities
766.5

 
760.4

Less: accumulated depreciation
409.1

 
410.1

Net facilities
$
357.4

 
$
350.3

Depreciation expense for owned assets for the years ended December 31, 2011 , 2010 and 2009 was $ 66.4 million , $ 66.3 million and $ 69.0 million , respectively.

NOTE 10.
Accounts Receivable Securitization Program & Financing Receivables
On September 23, 2009, the Company established an accounts receivable securitization program (the “Accounts Receivable Securitization Program”) with Société Générale Bank Nederland N.V. The maximum funding from receivables that may be sold into the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program and outstanding at any point in time is € 100 million ; however, there can be no assurance that the Company will generate sufficient eligible receivables to access the maximum availability. The original term of the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program was for one year, with the possibility of four additional annual extensions, assuming the Company and the participating sellers are in compliance with the applicable covenants. The Company extended the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program in September 2011 for one additional year.
During the year ended December 31, 2011 , the Company sold all of its eligible receivables into the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program. In addition to the above, the Company has the ability to access cash on a daily basis related to collections on sold receivables prior to the following settlement date with the bank.
The sold receivables were removed from the balance sheet in accordance with the guidance under ASC topic 860, Transfers and Servicing . The total amount of receivables sold under the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program during the year ended December 31, 2011 was € 816.8 million ($ 1,136.8 million at weighted average 2011 exchange rates). The amount of eligible receivables sold and outstanding at December 31, 2011 amounted to € 76.6 million ($ 99.3 million at December 31, 2011 exchange rates).
As a result of the sale, accounts receivable decreased by $ 99.3 million and cash and cash equivalents increased by $ 52.5 million . The remaining amount of proceeds of $ 46.8 million is a subordinated deposit, before the effect of cash collections, with Société Générale Bank Nederland N.V. at December 31, 2011 .
As a result of the Company's access to the cash collections of the sold receivables, the company collected $ 36.8 million of additional cash as of December 31, 2011 . Of these cash receipts, $ 24.4 million is classified on the consolidated balance sheet as loans payable to bank and $ 12.4 million reduced the subordinated deposit to $ 34.4 million which is classified as restricted cash on the consolidated balance sheet at December 31, 2011 .

56


Also, the Company has pledged unsold receivables under the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program of € 1.8 million ($ 2.3 million at December 31, 2011 exchange rates).
The fair value of the receivables sold equaled the carrying cost at time of sale, and no gain or loss was recorded as a result of the sale. The Company estimated the fair value of sold receivables using Level 3 inputs based on historical and anticipated performance of similar receivables, including historical and anticipated credit losses (if any). As part of the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program, the Company continues to service the receivables. The Company sells the receivables at face value, but receives actual funding net of the subordinated deposit account until collections are received from customers for the receivables sold. The Company is exposed to the credit losses of sold receivables up to the amount of its subordinated deposit account at each settlement date. Credit losses for receivables sold and past due amounts outstanding at December 31, 2011 were both immaterial. Servicing fees paid for the program were $ 1.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 .
On April 15, 2009, the Company entered into a € 35 million factoring program, which has a term of five years, in respect to accounts receivable from one of our customers. To date, we have not utilized this facility.
Other financing receivables include sales to reputable State Owned and Public Enterprises in China that are settled through notes receivable which are registered and endorsed to the Company. These notes receivable are fully secured and generally have contractual maturities of six months or less. These guaranteed notes are available to be discounted with banking institutions in China or transferred to suppliers to settle liabilities. The total amount of notes receivable discounted or transferred for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 were $ 62.8 million and $ 85.3 million , respectively, resulting in expenses of $ 0.6 million and $ 0.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, which are included in “Other non-operating expense, net.” The carrying amounts of these guaranteed notes receivable are $ 40.0 million and $ 22.4 million as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively, and are included in “other current assets” on the consolidated balance sheets. The Company monitors the credit quality of these notes through historical losses and current economic conditions with Chinese banks. As these receivables are guaranteed by banks and the Company has not experienced any historical losses nor is the Company expecting future credit losses, we have not established a loss provision against these receivables as of December 31, 2011 or December 31, 2010.

NOTE 11.
Goodwill and Intangible Assets
The following table summarizes the changes in the carrying amount of goodwill for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010.
 
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions)
 
2011
 
2010
Balance of goodwill, beginning of year
$
378.4

 
$
399.4

Foreign exchange translation
(14.5
)
 
(21.0
)
Balance of goodwill, end of year
$
363.9

 
$
378.4

The changes in the carrying value of intangible assets for the years ended December 31 are as follows:


57


 
 
Capitalized Software
 
Other Intangible Assets
 
Total
Gross intangible assets as of:
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2009
 
$
88.1

 
$
22.4

 
$
110.5

Additions
 
8.0

 
0.8

 
8.8

Disposals
 
(0.6
)
 

 
(0.6
)
Foreign exchange translation
 
(6.9
)
 
0.4

 
(6.5
)
December 31, 2010
 
88.6

 
23.6

 
112.2

Additions
 
6.9

 
2.1

 
9.0

Disposals
 
(2.6
)
 

 
(2.6
)
Foreign exchange translation
 
(7.2
)
 
(2.9
)
 
(10.1
)
December 31, 2011
 
$
85.7

 
$
22.8

 
$
108.5

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accumulated amortization as of:
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2009
 
$
(66.1
)
 
$
(0.9
)
 
$
(67.0
)
Amortization expense
 
(6.9
)
 
(4.2
)
 
(11.1
)
Disposals
 
0.6

 

 
0.6

Foreign exchange translation
 
5.5

 
(0.1
)
 
5.4

December 31, 2010
 
(66.9
)
 
(5.2
)
 
(72.1
)
Amortization expense
 
(7.5
)
 
(2.8
)
 
(10.3
)
Disposals
 
2.5

 

 
2.5

Foreign exchange translation
 
6.5

 
0.5

 
7.0

December 31, 2011
 
$
(65.4
)
 
$
(7.5
)
 
$
(72.9
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net intangible assets as of:
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2011
 
$
20.3

 
$
15.3

 
$
35.6


The Company will incur approximately $ 10 million to $14 million of amortization expense for each of the next five fiscal years.

Note 12.
Post-retirement Benefits
WABCO employees participate in a number of benefit plans. The plans include a 401(k) savings plan (the “Savings Plan”) for the Company's U.S. salaried and hourly employees and a pension plan for certain U.S. salaried and hourly employees. The Savings Plan is an individual-account defined contribution plan. WABCO employees in certain countries, primarily Germany, the United Kingdom, France and Switzerland participate in defined benefit plans sponsored by local WABCO legal entities.
Further, WABCO has assumed responsibility for certain retiree medical plans in the U.S. and a pension plan in Germany relating to former employees of Trane's Bath & Kitchen division.
Benefits under defined benefit pension plans on a worldwide basis are generally based on years of service and either employee's compensation during the last years of employment or negotiated benefit levels.
WABCO recognizes in its statement of financial position an asset for a defined benefit post-retirement plan's overfunded status or a liability for a plan's underfunded status. The significant long-term liability of $348.6 million on the consolidated balance sheet is primarily due to the underfunded plan in Germany, where the majority of the Company's prior and current employees are based.
The following table provides a reconciliation of the changes in pension and retirement health and life insurance benefit obligations and fair value of assets for the years ending December 31, 2011 and 2010, and a statement of the funded status as of December 31, 2011 and 2010:
 

58


 
2011
 
2011
 
2010
 
2010
(Amounts in millions)
Health & Life Ins. Benefits
 
Pension Benefits
 
Health & Life Ins. Benefits
 
Pension Benefits
Reconciliation of benefit obligation:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Obligation at beginning of year
$
17.8

 
$
481.6

 
$
18.2

 
$
490.1

Service cost

 
8.6

 

 
8.5

Interest cost
0.7

 
24.4

 
1.0

 
22.9

Participant contributions
0.4

 
0.3

 
0.4

 
0.3

Plan amendments

 

 

 
5.2

Actuarial loss / (gain)
(1.0
)
 
12.9

 
0.8

 
8.0

Benefit payments
(2.7
)
 
(29.4
)
 
(2.6
)
 
(27.2
)
Foreign exchange effects

 
(10.2
)
 

 
(27.8
)
Other

 
(0.5
)
 

 
1.6

Obligation at end of year
$
15.2

 
$
487.7

 
$
17.8

 
$
481.6

 

 
2011
 
2011
 
2010
 
2010
(Amounts in millions)  
Health & Life Ins. Benefits
 
Pension Benefits
 
Health & Life Ins. Benefits
 
Pension Benefits
Reconciliation of fair value of plan assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year
$

 
$
139.5

 
$

 
$
133.1

Actual return on assets

 
19.9

 

 
9.4

Employer contributions
2.3

 
25.8

 
2.2

 
26.0

Participant contributions
0.4

 
0.3

 
0.4

 
0.3

Benefit payments
(2.7
)
 
(29.4
)
 
(2.6
)
 
(27.2
)
Foreign exchange effects

 
(0.8
)
 

 
(1.5
)
Other expenses

 
(0.7
)
 

 
(0.6
)
Fair value of plan assets at end of year
$

 
$
154.6

 
$

 
$
139.5

Funded Status at December 31
$
(15.2
)
 
$
(333.1
)
 
$
(17.8
)
 
$
(342.1
)
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Amounts recognized in the balance sheet:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Noncurrent assets

 
21.4

 

 
4.6

Current liabilities
(1.8
)
 
(19.3
)
 
(2.3
)
 
(18.1
)
Noncurrent liabilities
(13.4
)
 
(335.2
)
 
(15.5
)
 
(328.6
)
Net amounts recognized in balance sheet:
$
(15.2
)
 
$
(333.1
)
 
$
(17.8
)
 
$
(342.1
)
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Cumulative amounts recognized in other Comprehensive Income consists of:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Prior service cost
$
0.3

 
$
0.1

 
$
0.2

 
$
0.2

Net actuarial loss
6.7

 
65.1

 
8.1

 
64.7

Total (before tax effects)
$
7.0

 
$
65.2

 
$
8.3

 
$
64.9

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Adjustments to post-retirement benefits accrual recognized in OCI:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Gross adjustments to post-retirement benefits accrual recognized in OCI (net of deferred tax of $0.1 in 2011 and $1.3 in 2010)
$
(1.3
)
 
$
1.3

 
$
0.5

 
$
1.1

 
The following table provides a summary of pension plans with accumulated benefit obligations in excess of assets as of December 31:
 

59


 
2011
2010
(Amounts in millions)  
Foreign Pension Plans
Foreign Pension Plans
For all plans:
 
 
Accumulated benefit obligation
$
448.1

$
444.4

For pension plans with accumulated benefit obligations in excess of plan assets:
 
 
Accumulated benefit obligation
$
317.7

$
312.3

Total post-retirement costs are shown below:
 
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions) 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Foreign pensions
$
25.1

 
$
25.4

 
$
27.6

Health & Life insurance benefits (Americas)
1.0

 
1.2

 
1.3

Total post-retirement costs, including accretion expense
$
26.1

 
$
26.6

 
$
28.9

Components of post-retirement costs are broken out in the tables below:
Pension Benefit Costs
 
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions)  
2011 Pensions
 
2010 Pensions
 
2009 Pensions
Service cost-benefits earned during period
$
8.6

 
$
8.5

 
$
7.7

Interest cost on projected benefit obligation
24.4

 
22.9

 
24.6

Less assumed return on plan assets
(10.0
)
 
(7.9
)
 
(5.4
)
Amortization of prior service cost

 
0.1

 
0.1

Amortization of net loss
2.1

 
1.8

 
0.6

Net defined benefit plan cost after curtailments
$
25.1

 
$
25.4

 
$
27.6

 
Other Post-Retirement Benefit Costs
 
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions)  
2011 Health & Life Ins. Benefits
 
2010 Health & Life Ins. Benefits
 
2009 Health & Life Ins. Benefits
Interest and service cost on projected benefit obligation
$
0.7

 
$
0.9

 
$
1.0

Amortization of net loss
0.3

 
0.3

 
0.3

Defined benefit plan cost
$
1.0

 
$
1.2

 
$
1.3

Amortization of prior service cost is computed on the straight-line method over the average remaining service period of active participants.
Major assumptions used in determining the benefit obligation and net cost for post-retirement plans are presented below as weighted averages:
 

60


Benefit Obligation at December 31,  
2011 Health & Life Ins. Benefits
 
2011 Foreign Pension Plans
 
2010 Health & Life Ins. Benefits
 
2010 Foreign Pension Plans
Discount rate
4.25
%
 
4.68
%
 
4.75
%
 
5.00
%
Salary growth
N/A

 
3.22
%
 
N/A

 
3.23
%
Net Periodic Pension Cost for the year
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Discount rate
4.75
%
 
5.00
%
 
5.25
%
 
5.25
%
Salary growth
N/A

 
3.23
%
 
N/A

 
3.23
%
Expected return on plan assets
N/A

 
5.99
%
 
N/A

 
6.19
%
The discount rate assumption in this chart changed from 2010 to 2011, resulting in a change in the pension benefit obligation. In the chart above that reconciles the change in benefit obligations for the year, the impact of the discount rate change is included in the actuarial loss / (gain) line item. The discount rate noted for foreign pension plans is a weighted average rate based on each of the applicable country's rates.
The assumed rate of return is a long-term investment return that takes into account the classes of assets held by the plan and expected returns for each class of assets. Return expectations reflect forward-looking analysis as well as historical experience.
WABCO's asset management strategy focuses on maintaining a diversified portfolio using various classes of assets to generate attractive returns while managing risk. The Company periodically reviews its target asset allocations for a given plan to ensure it aligns with the asset management strategy. In determining the target asset allocation for a given plan, consideration is given to the nature of its liabilities, and portfolios are periodically rebalanced with reference to the target level.
 
Asset Allocation  
2011
 
2010
 
2011 Target
 
2010 Target
Equity securities
18
%
 
22
%
 
24
%
 
24
%
Corporate debt securities
75
%
 
70
%
 
71
%
 
71
%
Other, including real estate
7
%
 
8
%
 
5
%
 
5
%
The 2011 target asset allocation was in line with the 2010 target allocation. The Company will continue to move towards these asset allocations in 2012.
All assets are measured at the current fair value. The Company determines fair value for each class of assets in its entirety using quoted prices in active markets for identical assets (Level 1). The Company has not changed the valuation techniques and inputs used during the periods presented. The fair values for each class of assets are presented below:
(Amounts in millions)  
2011
 
2010
Equity securities
$
28.4

 
$
30.7

Corporate debt securities
116.6

 
97.7

Other, including real estate
9.6

 
11.1

Total fair value of plan assets
$
154.6

 
$
139.5

WABCO makes contributions to funded pension plans that at a minimum, meet all statutory funding requirements. Contributions in 2011, including payment of benefits incurred by unfunded plans, totaled $ 28.1 million . Contributions in 2012 are expected to be in line with the contributions made during 2011.
 
Expected future benefit payments are shown in the table below:
 
(Amounts in millions)  
2012
2013
2014
2015
2016
2017-2021
Domestic plans without subsidy
$
1.8

$
1.8

$
1.7

$
1.6

$
1.5

$
5.8

Foreign pension plans
$
26.2

$
26.8

$
27.1

$
27.2

$
27.6

$
139.8

The weighted average annual assumed rate of increase in the health care cost trend rate was 8.5% for 2010, 8.0% for 2011 and is assumed to stay at 8.0% in 2012 and then gradually decline to 4.75% by 2019. The health care cost trend rate

61


assumption has the following effect:
 
(Amounts in millions)  
1% Increase   
1% Decrease   
Effect on the health care component of accumulated post-retirement obligation
$
0.9

$
(0.9
)
Effect on total of service and interest cost components of net periodic post-retirement health care benefit costs
$

$


NOTE 13.
Debt

On July 8, 2011 , the Company entered into a $400 million multi-currency five -year senior unsecured revolving credit facility ("revolving credit facility") with the lenders and agent banks party thereto, including Banc of America Securities Limited as agent, issuing bank and swingline lender, and Banc of America Securities Limited, Citigroup Global Markets Limited, Fortis Bank S.A./N.V., ING Belgium SA/NV, Société Générale Corporate & Investment Banking, The Bank of Tokyo-Mitsubishi UFJ, Ltd and The Royal Bank of Scotland NV, (Belgium) Branch, as mandated lead arrangers and bookrunners and Credit Lyonnais and Unicredit Bank AG as lead arrangers.

As of December 31, 2011 , this is our principal bank credit facility, and it expires on September 1, 2016 . It replaced our prior $800 million multi-currency five -year senior unsecured revolving credit facility.

Under the revolving credit facility, the Company may borrow, on a revolving basis, loans in an aggregate principal amount at any one time outstanding not in excess of $400 million . Up to $50 million under this facility may be used for issuing letters of credit, of which $ 48.7 million was unused as of December 31, 2011 , and up to $50 million is available in the form of swingline loans, all $ 50.0 million of which was available for use as of December 31, 2011 . At December 31, 2011 , the carrying amount of this facility approximated fair value. The balance outstanding on this facility as of December 31, 2011 , was $ 52.0 million in addition to $ 1.3 million of letters of credit. The Company has the intent and ability to carry its balance outstanding for at least a continuous twelve month period as of December 31, 2011 .
 
The proceeds of the borrowings under the revolving credit facility may be used to repurchase WABCO shares, finance acquisitions, refinance existing indebtedness and meet general financing requirements.

Interest on loans under the revolving credit facility will be calculated at a rate per annum equal to an applicable margin which can vary from 0.80% to 1.55% based on the Company's leverage ratio plus LIBOR for loans denominated in U.S. Dollars, EURIBOR for loans denominated in Euros, HIBOR for loans denominated in Hong Kong Dollars and SIBOR for loans denominated in Singapore Dollars, plus mandatory costs, if any.

The applicable margins used to determine the LIBOR loan rate are determined based upon the Company's leverage ratio, which represents the ratio of our consolidated net indebtedness on the last day of any fiscal quarter to consolidated adjusted EBITDA (earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization adjusted for certain items) for the period of four consecutive fiscal quarters ending on such day. The revolving credit facility also provides for certain of the borrowers to pay various fees including a participation fee on the amount of the lenders' commitments thereunder.

The revolving credit facility contains terms and provisions (including representations, covenants and conditions) customary for credit agreements of this type. Our primary financial covenant is a leverage test which requires net indebtedness not to exceed three times adjusted four quarter trailing EBITDA. Additional financial covenants include an interest coverage test and a maximum subsidiary indebtedness test. The interest coverage test requires three times interest expense not to exceed adjusted four quarter trailing EBITDA. The maximum subsidiary indebtedness test limits the total aggregate amount of indebtedness of WABCO's subsidiaries, excluding indebtedness under the revolving credit facility, to $400 million , of which not more than $150 million may be secured. Financial covenants are not subject to any future changes in U.S. GAAP accounting standards and all cash on the balance sheet can be deducted for net indebtedness purposes. In addition, expenses and payments related to any streamlining of WABCO’s operations are excluded when calculating the four quarter trailing adjusted EBITDA. Other covenants include delivery of financial reports and other information, compliance with laws including environmental laws and permits, ERISA and U.S. regulations, limitations on liens, mergers and sales of assets and change of business. At December 31, 2011 the Company had the ability to borrow an incremental $ 346.7 million under our revolving credit facility and we were in compliance with all the covenants.
As of December 31, 2011 , the Company's various subsidiaries had borrowings from banks totaling $ 26.2 million , of which $ 24.4 million relates to our Accounts Receivable Securitization Program referred to in Note 10 above. The remaining $ 1.8 million supports local working capital requirements.

62



Note 14.
Warranties, Guarantees, Commitments and Contingencies
Warranties
Products sold by WABCO are covered by a basic limited warranty with terms and conditions that vary depending upon the product and country in which it was sold. The limited warranty covers the equipment, parts and labor (in certain cases) necessary to satisfy the warranty obligation generally for a period of two years. Estimated product warranty expenses are accrued in cost of goods sold at the time the related sale is recognized. Estimates of warranty expenses are based primarily on warranty claims experience and specific customer contracts. Warranty expenses include accruals for basic warranties for product sold, as well as accruals for product recalls, service campaigns and other related events when they are known and estimable. To the extent WABCO experiences changes in warranty claim activity or costs associated with servicing those claims, its warranty accrual is adjusted accordingly. Warranty accrual estimates are updated based upon the most current warranty claims information available.
The following is a summary of changes in the Company’s product warranty liability for the years ended December 31, 2011 , 2010 and 2009 (amounts in millions).
 
Year Ended December 31,
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Balance of warranty costs accrued, beginning of period
$
44.9

 
$
45.8

 
57.8

Warranty costs accrued
41.9

 
32.6

 
17.9

Changes in accruals relating to pre-existing claims

 

 
5.3

Warranty claims settled
(33.0
)
 
(31.3
)
 
(35.9
)
Foreign exchange translation effects
(1.2
)
 
(2.2
)
 
0.7

Balance of warranty costs accrued, end of period
$
52.6

 
$
44.9

 
45.8

Current liability, included in current portion of warranties
$
42.3

 
$
41.7

 
43.1

Long-term liability, included in other liabilities
$
10.3

 
$
3.2

 
2.7

Guarantees and Commitments
    
Future minimum rental commitments under all non-cancelable operating leases with original terms in excess of one year in effect at December 31, 2011, are: $ 18.0 million in 2012; $ 13.1 million in 2013; $ 10.6 million in 2014; $ 8.8 million in 2015; $ 6.7 million in 2016 and $ 11.6 million thereafter, a total of $68.8 million . Net rental expense for all operating leases was $ 19.0 million , $ 16.1 million and $ 15.3 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 , 2010 and 2009, respectively.
The Company has bank guarantees for $ 27.9 million which is comprised of uncollateralized bank guarantees, of which $ 22.9 million is related to tax and other litigation, $ 1.3 million is related to letters of credit and $ 3.7 million is related to other items.
The Company has inventory and receivables that are pledged against a local bank facility in India to support local working capital requirements of approximately $ 8.5 million . Also, the Company has pledged unsold receivables under the Accounts Receivable Securitization Program of € 1.8 million ($ 2.3 million at December 31, 2011 exchange rates).
In the normal course of business we expect to purchase approximately $1.3 billion in 2012 of materials and services, and estimate that on average no more than approximately $152.9 million is outstanding at any one time in the form of legally binding commitments.
Contingencies
General
We are subject to proceedings, lawsuits and other claims related to products and other matters. We are required to assess the likelihood of any adverse judgments or outcomes to these matters as well as potential ranges of probable and reasonably possible losses. A determination of the amount of liability to be recorded, if any, for these contingencies is made after careful analysis of each individual issue.
Litigation

63


On June 23, 2010, the European Commission (the “Commission”) issued a decision imposing a total of € 326.1 million in fines, or approximately $ 400 million on the date of assessment (the “EC Fine”), on the former American Standard Companies Inc. (now Trane Inc., hereinafter referred to as “American Standard” or “Trane”), and certain of its European subsidiaries engaged in the Bath and Kitchen business and successor entities for infringements of European Union competition rules relating to the distribution of bathroom fixtures and fittings in a number of European countries. Pursuant to our Indemnification and Cooperation Agreement with Trane, WABCO Europe BVBA (an indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of WABCO) is responsible for, and is liable to indemnify Trane Inc. and Ideal Standard International (representing the successor to the Bath and Kitchen business, and owner of certain of the former American Standard subsidiaries) and their owners against the EC Fine.
As required by the Indemnification and Cooperation Agreement, WABCO paid the fine amount into escrow on August 30, 2010, using € 230.0 million of cash on hand and € 96.1 million of additional borrowings under a revolving credit facility. The funds were subsequently released from escrow and paid to the Commission. After reviewing all of the elements of the case, WABCO decided to appeal the decision in order to try to have the fine reduced. On September 8, 2010, WABCO filed its appeal in the General Court of the European Union, located in Luxembourg. The Company believes that a decision on the appeal will take at least five years from the date the appeal was filed.
Other
In conjunction with the Tax Sharing Agreement, as further discussed in "Note 16. Tax and Indemnification Liabilities Transferred from Trane to WABCO," WABCO is responsible for certain tax and indemnification liabilities. These liabilities include probable indemnification liabilities to Trane of $14.4 million as of December 31, 2011 . It is reasonably possible that the Company could incur losses in excess of the amounts accrued. Although this amount cannot be estimated, we believe that any additional losses would not have a material adverse impact on the consolidated financial statements.

Note 15.
Income Taxes
Income before income taxes and the applicable provision for income taxes were:
 
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions)  
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Income before income taxes:
 
 
 
 
 
Domestic
$
72.4

 
$
33.5

 
$
52.5

Foreign
332.5

 
(210.8
)
 
(44.5
)
 
$
404.9

 
$
(177.3
)
 
$
8.0

Provision / (benefit) for income taxes:
 
 
 

 
 

Current:
 

 
 

 
 

Domestic
$
24.9

 
$
11.2

 
$
5.0

Foreign
9.9

 
28.3

 
5.3

 
34.8

 
39.5

 
10.3

Deferred:
 

 
 

 
 

Domestic
(0.4
)
 
(1.3
)
 

Foreign
2.3

 
(1.3
)
 
(21.0
)
 
1.9

 
(2.6
)
 
(21.0
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total provision / (benefit)
$
36.7

 
$
36.9

 
$
(10.7
)
A reconciliation between the actual income tax expense provided and the income taxes computed by applying the statutory federal income tax rate of 35.0% in 2011, 2010 and 2009 to the income before income taxes is as follows:
 

64


 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions)  
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Tax provision at statutory rate
$
141.7

 
$
(62.1
)
 
$
2.8

Separation related taxes and contingencies
1.8

 
4.7

 
5.2

Foreign earnings taxed at other than 35%
(76.6
)
 
(45.5
)
 
(10.7
)
Decrease in valuation allowance
(33.4
)
 

 

EC fine tax contingency

 
134.9

 

Tax contingency accruals
18.8

 
4.3

 
3.3

Benefit of tax reversals
(19.2
)
 
(3.6
)
 
(14.8
)
Equity Compensation
4.2

 
3.9

 
4.0

Other, net
(0.6
)
 
0.3

 
(0.5
)
Total provision
$
36.7

 
$
36.9

 
$
(10.7
)

The effective income tax rates for 2011 and 2010 were 9.1% and (20.8)% , respectively. As further discussed below, the Company did not recognize a tax benefit of $ 134.9 million at December 31, 2010 foreign exchange rates for the payment of the EC fine in the third quarter of 2010. The income tax provision for 2011 is principally driven by income taxes in profitable jurisdictions offset by benefits related to ongoing foreign tax planning activities, a decrease of a valuation allowance, and the release of certain tax accruals as a consequence of the settlement of foreign tax audits and the expiration of a statute of limitation.
In addition, the Company provided a tax provision of $12.7 million during the fourth quarter due to the Company's decision to repatriate earnings from a foreign affiliate of approximately $299 million as further discussed below. Changes in U.S. or foreign tax laws or rulings may have a significant impact on our effective tax rate.

The approximate dollar and diluted earnings per share amounts of tax reductions related to tax holidays and incentive tax credits in various countries in which the Company does business were $ 4.1 million and $ 0.06 in 2011, $ 4.3 million and $ 0.07 in 2010 and $ 1.2 million and $ 0.02 in 2009, respectively. The tax holidays and incentive tax credits expire at various dates through 2017.

The following table details the gross deferred tax liabilities and assets and the related valuation allowances:
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions)  
2011  
 
2010
Deferred tax liabilities:
 
 
 
Basis difference in minority interest
$
11.2

 
$
11.5

Facilities (accelerated depreciation, capitalized interest and purchase accounting differences)
22.2

 
22.4

Inventory (LIFO)
1.7

 
1.7

Intangibles
4.1

 
5.2

Other

 
0.1

 
$
39.2

 
$
40.9

Deferred tax assets:
 
 
 
Foreign net operating losses and tax credits
$
174.4

 
$
206.9

Valuation allowances
(130.4
)
 
(163.8
)
Post-retirement and other employee benefits
23.1

 
23.4

Intangibles
4.4

 
4.8

Warranties
2.2

 
2.9

Other
7.2

 
5.2

 
$
80.9

 
$
79.4

 
 
 
 
Net deferred tax assets
$
41.7

 
$
38.5


At December 31, 2011 , the Company has $ 525.6 million of net operating loss carry forwards (NOLs) available for utilization in future years. Approximately $ 494.0 million of such NOLs have an unlimited life and the remainder is available for periods of up to 7 years. As of December 31, 2011, the Company has provided a full valuation allowance of $ 130.4 million

65


representing the value of the associated deferred tax asset with regard to the $ 383.6 million of unlimited life NOLs. These NOLs consist of NOLs inherited by WABCO upon separation from Trane as well as losses incurred in post-spin years.

Unrecognized tax benefits at December 31, 2011 amounted to $ 66.1 million related to the WABCO business and $ 5.8 million related to WABCO obligations directly to tax authorities for Trane’s Bath and Kitchen business as further discussed in Note 16. Tax and Indemnification Liabilities Transferred from Trane to WABCO. The Company will recognize $13.6 million of tax benefits in the first quarter of 2012 due to certain government filings submitted in January 2012. It is also reasonably possible that $5.2 million of additional tax benefits will be recognized within the next 12 months. Moreover, $ 67.0 million of the unrecognized tax benefits are classified as long-term liabilities and $ 4.9 million are classified as short-term liabilities. Approximately $ 0.9 million of long-term unrecognized tax benefits and $ 4.9 million of the short-term unrecognized tax benefits relate to WABCO’s obligations to tax authorities for Trane’s Bath and Kitchen business. Interest related to unrecognized tax benefits recorded in the 2011 and 2010 consolidated statement of income were $ 0.8 million and $ 3.1 million , respectively. Total accrued interest at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 was approximately $ 4.6 million , and $ 8.7 million , respectively. The Company recognizes accrued interest and penalties accrued related to unrecognized tax benefits in income tax expense. No penalties have been accrued related to these unrecognized tax benefits.

During the third quarter of 2010, the Company recorded an uncertain tax position of approximately $ 135.8 million at then foreign exchange rates related to tax deductions in foreign jurisdictions for the payment of the EC fine. The deduction claimed for $ 396.9 million of the EC fine adds to existing net operating losses in a foreign jurisdiction that has a full valuation allowance against such NOLs. The use of a valuation allowance as a substitute for recording an unrecognized tax position is not permitted under US GAAP. As a result, the unrecognized tax benefit must be recorded as a reduction of the deferred tax asset. Consequently, the balance sheet amounts for the unrecognized tax benefit do not reflect the $ 142.4 million at December 31, 2011 foreign exchange rates related to the EC fine; however, such benefit is required to be disclosed as part of the tabular rollforward for unrecognized tax benefits provided below.

A reconciliation of the beginning and ending balances of unrecognized tax benefits is as follows (exclusive of interest):
 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions) 
2011
 
2010
Beginning balance, January 1
$
208.3

 
$
74.5

Additions for tax positions related to current year
19.7

 
139.2

Reductions for tax positions related to prior years
(12.9
)
 

Cash settlements
(10.6
)
 
(3.6
)
Expirations of statute of limitations
(5.2
)
 

Foreign exchange
10.3

 
(1.8
)
Ending balance, December 31
$
209.6

 
$
208.3


We conduct business globally and, as a result, WABCO or one or more of our subsidiaries file income tax returns in the U.S. federal, state and local, and foreign jurisdictions. In the normal course of business, we are subject to examination by taxing authorities throughout the world, including such major jurisdictions as Belgium, Brazil, China, France, Germany, the Netherlands, Poland, the United Kingdom and the United States. With no material exceptions, the Company is no longer subject to examinations by tax authorities for years before 2007. The Company may realize a reduction of up to $ 4.9 million of unrecognized tax benefits to occur within 12 months as a result of projected resolutions of worldwide tax disputes or applicable statute closings. In addition, of the 19.7 million additions for unrecognized tax benefits in 2011, the Company will release $13.6 million in the first quarter of 2012, due to certain filings submitted by the Company to taxing authorities in January 2012. US GAAP required the recording of this unrecognized tax benefit at December 31, 2011 since it is not permissible for a tax position to be recognized, derecognized, or remeasured due to changes subsequent to the balance sheet date, but prior to the issuance of the financial statements. It is also reasonably possible that $5.2 million of additional tax benefits will be recognized within the next 12 months. The reversals of $ 28.7 million and $ 3.6 million during 2011 and 2010, respectively, relate to the closure of foreign tax audits and the expiration of statutes of limitation.

As a result of the allocation of purchase accounting (principally goodwill) to foreign subsidiaries, the book basis in the net assets of the foreign subsidiaries exceeds the related U.S. tax basis in the subsidiaries' stock. Such investments are considered permanent in duration and accordingly, no deferred taxes have been provided on such differences, which are significant. The Company considers the earnings of substantially all of its foreign subsidiaries to be permanently reinvested outside the U.S. and as such no additional U.S. tax cost has been provided. The Company has provided for tax at the U.S. tax rate for its Brazilian affiliate's current year earnings in 2011. The Company estimates the amount of its unremitted foreign

66


earnings permanently reinvested outside the U.S. to be approximately $ 250 million as December 31, 2011, however, it is not practicable to estimate the tax liability that would arise if the earnings that are considered permanently reinvested were remitted to the U.S. The 2011 tax provision includes a tax charge of $12.7 million due to the Company's decision to repatriate foreign earnings of approximately $299 million that were previously determined to be permanently reinvested outside of the U.S., in order to take advantage of a unique opportunity from the impact of the EU fine on its pool of foreign earnings. The Company continues to assert permanent reinvestment outside the U.S. with respect to the remainder of its foreign earnings and at this time, the Company does not have any plans or needs to repatriate additional earnings from its foreign subsidiaries except for Brazil.

Note 16.
Tax and Indemnification Liabilities Transferred from Trane to WABCO
Pursuant to the Tax Sharing Agreement between Trane and WABCO, entered into on July 16, 2007, and other agreements with Trane as filed in WABCO’s Form 10 prior to its spin-off from Trane, WABCO is responsible for certain tax contingencies and indemnification liabilities. As noted in Note 15. Income Taxes, the liabilities as of December 31, 2011 include $ 5.8 million related to non-U.S. entities of Trane’s former Bath and Kitchen business but for which WABCO entities have probable obligations directly to non-U.S. tax authorities. In addition, as of December 31, 2011 , the Company had probable indemnification liabilities of $ 14.4 million , of which $ 3.2 million is classified within long-term liabilities on the balance sheet and $ 11.2 million is classified within short-term liabilities. It is reasonably possible that the Company could incur losses in excess of the amounts accrued. Although this amount cannot be estimated, we believe that any additional losses would not have a material adverse impact on the consolidated financial statements.
During 2011, approximately $ 25.4 million of indemnification liabilities was reversed in the statement of income due to the expiration of a statute of limitations and the settlement of a foreign tax audit.
Under an indemnification agreement, WABCO Brazil is responsible for certain claims related to its business for periods prior to the spin-off of WABCO from American Standard. In particular, there are tax claims pending in various stages of the Brazilian legal process related to income, social contribution and/or value added taxes for which a contingency exists and which may or may not ultimately be incurred by the Company. The estimated total amount of the claims as of December 31, 2011 is $ 43.6 million including interest. However, based on management’s assessment and advice of our external legal counsel, the Company believes that it has valid arguments in all of these cases and the likelihood of loss is reasonably possible and thus no accrual is required at this time.

NOTE 17. Related Party Transactions
Investments in and Advances to Unconsolidated Joint Ventures
WABCO has three investments in affiliates that are accounted for by the equity method. The first of these investments is in Meritor WABCO. Meritor WABCO, in which WABCO has a 50% equity ownership, markets braking systems products and sells the majority of WABCO products in the United States. The second of these investments is in WABCO Automotive South Africa (“WABCO SA”). WABCO SA, in which WABCO has a 49% equity ownership, is a distributor of breaking systems products and sells WABCO products primarily in South Africa. The third investment is in WABCOWURTH Workshop Services GmbH (“WABCOWURTH”). WABCOWURTH, in which WABCO has a 50% equity ownership, supplies commercial vehicle workshops, fleet owners and operators and end users internationally with its multi-brand technology diagnostic system.
As of December 31, 2011 , WABCO has net investments in and advances to Meritor WABCO of $ 13.6 million , WABCO SA of $ 2.5 million and WABCOWURTH of $ 0.3 million . WABCO received dividends from the joint ventures of $ 14.4 million , $ 8.4 million and $ 6.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 , 2010 and 2009, respectively. WABCO obtained a majority control of WABCO India in 2009 and upon obtaining control, WABCO India's results of operations, beginning June 2009, are included in the consolidated financial statements of the Company.
 
(Amounts in Millions)
WABCO Sales to   
 
WABCO Purchases from   
Joint Venture
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Meritor WABCO
$
174.0

 
$
127

 
$
75.8

 
$
0.2

 
$
0.1

 
$

WABCO SA
7.6

 
5.8

 
3.9

 

 

 

WABCO India

 

 
0.6

 

 

 
1.0

WABCOWURTH
0.2

 
0.1

 

 

 

 

 

67


(Amounts in Millions)
WABCO Receivables from
 
 
WABCO Payables to
 
Joint Venture
 
2011
 
2010
 
2011
 
2010
Meritor WABCO
$
32.1

 
$
24.5

 
$

 
$

WABCO SA
2.3

 
1.7

 

 

WABCOWURTH
0.1

 
1.2

 

 


Consolidated Joint Ventures

WABCO has three fully consolidated joint ventures. The first of these joint ventures is in Japan with Sanwa-Seiki that distributes WABCO's products in the local market. The second joint venture is in the U.S. with Cummins Engine Co. ("Cummins"), a manufacturing partnership formed to produce air compressors designed by WABCO. The third joint venture is with Guangdong FUWA Heavy Industry Co., Ltd., (“FUWA”) to produce air disc brakes for commercial trailers in China. FUWA is the largest manufacturer of commercial trailer axles in China and in the world.

(Amounts in Millions)
WABCO Sales to   
 
WABCO Purchases from   
Joint Venture
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Sanwa-Seiki
0.2

 
0.2

 
0.1

 
39.3

 
35.8

 
23.8

Cummins
68.5

 
44.3

 
47.0

 

 

 

FUWA
4.1

 

 

 

 

 



NOTE 18. Geographic Information
WABCO is a fully integrated global business with management structures established in a variety of ways, including around products, distribution channels and key customers. Our largest customer is Daimler, which accounted for 12% , 13% and 12% of our sales in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Volvo accounted for 11% , 10% and 8% of our sales in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. WABCO's plants, engineering, technical support, distribution centers and other support functions are shared among various product families and serve all distribution channels with many customers. Based on the organizational structure, as well as the nature of financial information available and reviewed by the Company's chief operating decision maker to assess performance and make decisions about resource allocations, the Company has concluded that its total WABCO operations represent one reportable segment and that WABCO's performance and future net cash flow perspectives are best understood and assessed as such.

European sales for the years ended December 31, 2011 , 2010 and 2009 accounted for 62% , 60% and 65% of total sales, respectively.  Asian sales for the years ended December 31, 2011 , 2010 and 2009 accounted for 19% , 22% and 18% of total sales, respectively.  We are strongly rooted in China and India and have achieved a leading position in the marketplace through increasingly close connectivity to customers. We are further strengthened in Asia by an outstanding network of suppliers, manufacturing sites and engineering hubs.
Geographic Data

68


 
Year Ended December 31,
(Amounts in millions)
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Product Sales:
 
 
 
 
 
OEM
$
2,150.4

 
$
1,605.6

 
$
1,024.2

Aftermarket
643.7

 
570.1

 
467.3

Sales-Geographic distribution (a):
 
 
 
 
 
United States
$
246.2

 
$
173.6

 
$
124.7

Europe (countries below are included in this total)
1,737.5

 
1,318.7

 
970.1

Germany
759.0

 
579.6

 
417.1

France
111.9

 
90.0

 
72.9

Sweden
238.2

 
171.2

 
98.9

Other (countries below are included in this total)
810.4

 
683.4

 
396.7

Japan
104.6

 
82.7

 
50.5

China
162.1

 
159.7

 
94.4

Brazil
195.3

 
153.1

 
87.6

India
181.7

 
158.4

 
65.9

Total sales
$
2,794.1

 
$
2,175.7

 
$
1,491.5

 
(a)
Sales to external customers are classified by country of destination.
 
As of December 31,
(Amounts in millions)
 
2011
 
2010
 
2009
Long-lived Assets (b)
 
 
 
 
 
Geographic distribution:
 
 
 
 
 
United States
$
11.9

 
$
7.3

 
$
6.2

Europe (countries below are included in this total)
576.2

 
580.6

 
639.5

Germany
295.6

 
324.9

 
361.0

Poland
79.5

 
80.9

 
84.3

Other (countries below are included in this total)
209.0

 
207.4

 
187.0

India
98.7

 
104.6

 
98.3

Total long-lived assets
$
797.1

 
$
795.3

 
$
832.7

(b)Amounts are presented on a gross basis

NOTE 19. Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities

ASC topic 815, Derivatives and Hedging , requires a company to recognize all of its derivative instruments as either assets or liabilities on the balance sheet at fair value. The accounting for changes in the fair value of a derivative instrument depends on whether it qualifies and has been designated as a relationship hedge. For those derivative instruments that are designated and qualify as hedging instruments, a company must designate the hedging instrument, based upon the exposure being hedged, as a fair value hedge, cash flow hedge, or a hedge of a net investment in a foreign operation.
    
The Company recognizes all derivative financial instruments in the consolidated balance sheet at fair value using Level 2 inputs and these are classified as “other current assets,” “other assets,” “other accrued liabilities” or “other liabilities” on the consolidated balance sheet. Level 2 inputs used by the Company in valuing its derivative instruments include model-based valuation techniques for which all significant assumptions are observable in the market. The earnings impact resulting from changes in the fair value of derivative instruments is recorded in the same line item in the consolidated statement of operations as the underlying exposure being hedged or in accumulated other comprehensive income (AOCI) for derivatives that qualify and have been designated as cash flow hedges or hedges of a net investment in a foreign operation. Any ineffective portion of a financial instrument's change in fair value is recognized in earnings together with changes in the fair value of any derivatives not designated as relationship hedges.


69


Foreign exchange contracts are used by the Company to offset the earnings impact relating to the variability in exchange rates on certain assets and liabilities denominated in non-functional currencies and have not been designated as relationship hedges. As of December 31, 2011 , forward contracts for an aggregate notional amount of € 205.1 million ($ 265.9 million at December 31, 2011 exchange rates) were outstanding with an average duration of one month. The fair value of derivative assets at December 31, 2011 is $1.1 million and the fair value of derivative liabilities at December 31, 2011 is $1.5 million .
 
For the year ended December 31, 2011 , the Company recognized net gains on its derivative instruments of $0.2 million , of which $1.5 million expense is recognized in "cost of sales" and $1.7 million income is recognized in "other non-operating expense, net" on the consolidated statement of operations. As the Company did not enter into derivative contracts during 2010, no gain or loss was recorded.

NOTE 20. Quarterly Data (Unaudited)
 
 
Year 2011
(Amounts in millions)
First
  
Second
  
Third
  
Fourth
Sales
$
678.2

  
$
737.7

  
$
706.3

  
$
672.0

Cost of sales
481.9

  
520.0

  
501.9

  
482.5

Gross profit
196.3

  
217.7

  
204.4

  
189.5

Income before income taxes
115.1

  
100.5

  
96.0

  
93.2

Income tax (benefit) / expense
(3.2
)
  
10.6

  
9.1

  
20.1

Net income
114.7

  
88.6

  
83.8

  
69.8

Net income per common share
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
Basic
$
1.71

  
$
1.31

  
$
1.25

  
$
1.07

Diluted
$
1.66

  
$
1.26

  
$
1.22

  
$
1.04



 
Year 2010
(Amounts in millions)
First
  
Second
  
Third
  
Fourth
Sales
$
491.1

  
$
512.3

  
$
545.2

  
$
627.2

Cost of sales
350.9

  
363.0

  
397.0

  
449.7

Gross profit
140.2

  
149.3

  
148.2

  
177.5

Income before income taxes
41.3

  
(350.3
)
  
57.6

  
74.1

Income tax expense
7.6

  
12.1

  
10.4

  
6.7

Net income / (loss)
$
30.7

  
$
(365.4
)
  
$
44.0

  
$
64.6

Net income per common share
 
  
 
  
 
  
 
Basic
$
0.48

  
$
(5.68
)
  
$
0.68

  
$
0.99

Diluted
$
0.47

  
$
(5.68
)
  
$
0.66

  
$
0.96



The sum of each value line for the four quarters does not necessarily equal the amount reported for the full year because of rounding.

The income tax benefit recorded in the first quarter of 2011 is the net result of the release of tax accruals as a consequence of the settlement of foreign tax audits, taxes on earnings in profitable jurisdictions, income offset by fully valued net operating losses, the accrual of interest on uncertain tax positions and benefits from certain foreign tax planning.

The net loss recorded in the second quarter of 2010 is a result of the Commission issuance of a decision imposing a total of € 326.1 million in fines, or approximately $ 400 million on the date of assessment, on the former American Standard Companies Inc., and certain of its European subsidiaries engaged in the Bath and Kitchen business and successor entities for infringements of European Union competition rules relating to the distribution of bathroom fixtures and fittings in a number of European countries.

70


ITEM 9.      CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
None.

ITEM 9A.      CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
The Company has established a Disclosure Controls Committee that assists the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer in their evaluation of the Company's disclosure controls and procedures. Our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have concluded, based on their evaluation as of the end of the period covered by this report, that our disclosure controls and procedures, as defined in the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, Rule 13a-15(e), are (i) effective to ensure that the information required to be disclosed in the reports that the Company files or submits under the Securities Act of 1934 is recorded, processed, summarized and reported, within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission's rules and forms, and (ii) is accumulated and communicated to the Company's management, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure. There have been no changes in our internal control over financial reporting during the most recent fiscal quarter that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
 
Management's Report On Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Company. The Company's internal control over financial reporting is designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of consolidated financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. The Company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that:
 
 
(i)
pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company,
 
 
(ii)
provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of consolidated financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company, and
 
 
(iii)
provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company's assets that could have a material effect on the consolidated financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of the effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies and procedures included in such controls may deteriorate.
The Company conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting based upon the framework in Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Based upon such evaluation, our management concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2011.

The Company's effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting, as of December 31, 2011, has been audited by Ernst & Young Bedrijfsrevisoren BCVBA/Reviseurs d'Entreprises SCCRL, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their attestation report which is included immediately below.
WABCO Holdings Inc.
February 17, 2012

71

Table of Contents


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

The Board of Directors and Shareholders of WABCO Holdings Inc.

We have audited WABCO Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries' internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (the COSO criteria). WABCO Holdings Inc.'s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the accompanying Management's Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the company's internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion .

A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

In our opinion, WABCO Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on the COSO criteria.

We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of WABCO Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related consolidated statements of operations, shareholders' equity and comprehensive income / (loss), and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011 and our report dated February 17, 2012 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

Ernst & Young Bedrijfsrevisoren BCVBA/Reviseurs d'Entreprises SCCRL

Represented by:
/s/ Harry Everaerts,
Partner
Brussels, Belgium
February 17, 2012


ITEM 9B.      OTHER INFORMATION
None.

72

Table of Contents


PART III

ITEM 10.
DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
Pursuant to instruction G(3) to Form 10-K, the information required by Item 10 with respect to the Directors of the Company set forth under the heading “Proposal 1 - Election of Directors” and “Directors” in the Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed within 120 days following the end of the fiscal year covered by this report is incorporated herein by reference.
The information required by Item 10 with respect to the executive officers of the Company has been included in Part I of this Form 10-K (as Item 4A) under the heading “Executive Officers of the Registrant” in reliance on Instruction G(3) of Form 10-K and Instruction 3 to Item 401(b) of Regulation S-K.
Pursuant to instruction G(3) to Form 10-K, information concerning the Audit Committee and audit committee financial expert disclosure set forth under the headings “Governance - Board Matters and Committee Membership” and “- Committees of the Board - Audit Committee” in the Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed within 120 days following the end of the fiscal year covered by this report is incorporated herein by reference.
Pursuant to instruction G(3) to Form 10-K, information concerning compliance with Section 16(a) of the Securities Act of 1933 by officers and directors of the Company set forth under the heading “Certain Relationships or Related Person Transactions and Section 16 Reporting Compliance - Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” in the Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed within 120 days following the end of the fiscal year covered by this report is incorporated herein by reference.
Information regarding our Code of Conduct and Ethics set forth under the caption “Code of Conduct and Ethics” in Item 1 of Part I of this Form 10-K is incorporated herein by reference.
ITEM 11.
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
Pursuant to Instruction G(3) to Form 10-K, information concerning director and officer executive compensation and related matters set forth under the headings “Report of the Compensation, Nominating and Governance Committee,” “Compensation Discussion and Analysis,” “Executive Compensation” and “Director Compensation” in the Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed within 120 days following the end of the fiscal year covered by this report is incorporated herein by reference.
Pursuant to instruction G(3) to Form 10-K, information concerning compensation committee interlocks and insider participation set forth under the headings “Governance - Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation” in the Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed within 120 days following the end of the fiscal year covered by this report is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 12.
SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
Pursuant to Instruction G(3) to Form 10-K, information concerning shares of common stock of the Company beneficially owned by management set forth under the heading “Common Stock Ownership of Officers, Directors and Significant Shareholders” in the Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed within 120 days following the end of the fiscal year covered by this report is incorporated herein by reference.
Pursuant to Instruction G(3) to Form 10-K, information concerning securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans set forth under the heading “Equity Compensation Plans” in the Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed within 120 days following the end of the fiscal year covered by this report is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 13.
CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS AND, DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE
Pursuant to Instruction G(3) to Form 10-K, information concerning certain relationships and related party transactions and director independence set forth under the headings “Certain Relationships or Related Person Transactions and Section 16 Reporting Compliance - Certain Relationships and Related Person Transactions,” and “Governance - Independence Standards

73

Table of Contents

for Board Service” and “- Availability of Corporate Governance Materials” in the Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed within 120 days following the end of the fiscal year covered by this report is incorporated herein by reference.

ITEM 14.
PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES
Pursuant to Instruction G(3) to Form 10-K, information concerning principal accounting fees and services set forth under the heading “Audit Committee Matters - Audit Committee's Pre-Approval Policies and Procedures” and “- Audit and Non-Audit Fees” in the Company's definitive proxy statement to be filed within 120 days following the end of the fiscal year covered by this report is incorporated herein by reference.

74

Table of Contents


PART IV
ITEM 15.
EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
(a)
1. and 2. Financial statements and financial statement schedules
The financial statements and financial statement schedule listed in the Index to Financial Statements and Financial Statement Schedule on the following page are incorporated herein by reference.
(b) The exhibits to this Report are listed on the accompanying Index to Exhibits and are incorporated herein by reference or are file as part of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

75

Table of Contents

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULE
 
 
Page No.
 
 
 
1
Financial Statements:
 
 
 
 
 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
 
 
 
Consolidated Statements of Operations for years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
 
 
 
 
Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2011 and 2010
 
 
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows for years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
 
 
 
 
Consolidated Statement of Shareholders' Equity and Comprehensive Income / (Loss) for years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
 
 
 
 
Notes to Financial Statements
 
 
 
2
Financial statement schedule, years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
 
 
 
 
 
Schedule II - Valuation and Qualifying Accounts
All other schedules have been omitted because the information is not applicable or is not material or because the information required is included in the financial statements or the notes thereto.
 

76

Table of Contents



SCHEDULE II-VALUATION AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
Years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009
(Amounts in thousands)
 
Description
  
Balance
Beginning
of Period
  
Adjustments to Amounts Provided in Prior Years
  
Deductions
 
 
Foreign
Currency
Translation
Effects
 
Balance
End of
Period
2011:
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Reserve deducted from assets:
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for doubtful accounts receivable
  
$
7,706

  
$
(424
)
 
$
(3,840
)
(A)
 
$
(17
)
 
$
3,425

2010:
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Reserve deducted from assets:
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for doubtful accounts receivable
  
$
9,305

  
$
(315
)
 
$
(645
)
(A)
 
$
(639
)
 
$
7,706

2009:
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Reserve deducted from assets:
  
 
  
 
  
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for doubtful accounts receivable
  
$
6,855

  
$
2,675

  
$
(565
)
(A)
 
$
340

 
$
9,305

(A) Accounts charged off
 

77

Table of Contents


SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

WABCO HOLDINGS INC.

By: /s/ Jacques Esculier
Jacques Esculier
Chief Executive Officer and Director

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

Signatures
Title
Date
 
 
 
/s/ Jacques Esculier
Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of Directors
February 17, 2012
Jacques Esculier
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
 
 
 
/s/ Ulrich Michel
Chief Financial Officer
February 17, 2012
Ulrich Michel
(Principal Financial Officer)
 
 
 
 
/s/ Todd Weinblatt
Vice President and Controller
February 17, 2012
Todd Weinblatt
(Principal Accounting Officer)
 
 
 
 
*
Director
February 17, 2012
James F. Hardymon
 
 
 
 
 
*
Director
February 17, 2012
G. Peter D'Aloia
 
 
 
 
 
*
Director
February 17, 2012
John F. Fiedler
 
 
 
 
 
*
Director
February 17, 2012
Dr. Juergen Gromer
 
 
 
 
 
*
Director
February 17, 2012
Mary Petrovich
 
 
 
 
 
*
Director
February 17, 2012
Kenneth J. Martin
 
 
 
 
 
*
Director
February 17, 2012
Michael T. Smith
 
 
 
 
 
*
Director
February 17, 2012
Donald J. Stebbins
 
 

* Signed by Attorney-in-fact
/s/ Vincent Pickering
Vincent Pickering
Attorney-in-fact


78

Table of Contents

WABCO HOLDINGS INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES
INDEX TO EXHIBITS
(The File Number of the Registrant, WABCO Holdings Inc., is 1-33332)
Certain of the following exhibits, designated with an asterisk (*) are filed herewith. The exhibits not so designated have been previously filed by the registrant with the Commission and are incorporated herein by reference to the documents indicated in brackets, following the descriptions of such exhibits.
 
Exhibit No.
Description
  2.1
Separation and Distribution Agreement, dated as of July 16, 2007, by and between Trane Inc. and WABCO Holdings Inc. (previously filed as Exhibit 2.1 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on July 20, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
  3.1
Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (previously filed as Exhibit 3.1 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on July 18, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
  3.2
Amended and Restated By-Laws of WABCO Holdings Inc. (previously filed as Exhibit 3.2 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on July 18, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
  4.1
Rights Agreement, dated July 16, 2007, by and between WABCO Holdings Inc. and The Bank of New York (previously filed as Exhibit 4.1 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on July 18, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
  4.2
Certificate of Designation of Junior Participating Cumulative Preferred Stock (previously filed as Exhibit 4.2 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on July 18, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
  4.3
Rights Certificate (attached as an exhibit to the Rights Agreement, dated July 16, 2007 filed as Exhibit 4.1 hereto).
 
 
  4.4
Form of Specimen Common Stock Certificate (previously filed as Exhibit 4.4 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.1
Tax Sharing Agreement, dated as of July 16, 2007, by and among Trane Inc. and certain of its subsidiaries and WABCO Holdings Inc. and certain of its subsidiaries (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on July 20, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.2
Employee Matters Agreement, dated July 16, 2007, by and between Trane Inc. and WABCO Holdings Inc. (previously filed as Exhibit 10.3 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on July 20, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.3
Indemnification and Cooperation Agreement, dated as of July 16, 2007, by and among Trane Inc. and certain of its subsidiaries and WABCO Holdings Inc. and certain of its subsidiaries (previously filed as Exhibit 10.4 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on July 20, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.4
WABCO Holdings Inc. Omnibus Incentive Plan (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's Form S-8 (File No. 333-144906), filed on July 27, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.5
Amendment to WABCO Holdings Inc. Omnibus Incentive Plan.*
 
 
10.6
WABCO Holdings Inc. 2009 Omnibus Incentive Plan (previously filed as Exhibit B to the Company's Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A (File No. 001-33332), filed on April 17, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.7
Amendment to WABCO Holdings Inc. 2009 Omnibus Incentive Plan.*
 
 

79

Table of Contents

10.8
Form of Indemnification Agreement (previously filed as Exhibit 10.6 to the Company's Form 10, as amended (File No. 001-33332), filed on May 23, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference) (Entered into with all executive officers and all members of the Board of Directors, as reported in Form 8-Ks filed by the Company on August 2, 2007 and September 5, 2007).
 
 
10.9
Form of WABCO Holdings Inc. Stock Option Grant Agreement for U.S. Employees (previously filed as Exhibit 10.7 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.10
Form of WABCO Holdings Inc. Stock Option Grant Agreement for Non-U.S. Employees (previously filed as Exhibit 10.8 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.11
Form of WABCO Holdings Inc. Restricted Unit Grant Agreement for U.S. Employees (previously filed as Exhibit 10.9 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.12
Form of WABCO Holdings Inc. Restricted Unit Grant Agreement for Non-U.S. Employees (previously filed as Exhibit 10.10 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.13
Form of Performance-Based Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on July 28, 2011 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.14
WABCO Holdings Inc. Change of Control Severance Plan (previously filed as Exhibit 10.11 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.15
Amendment No. 1 to WABCO Holdings Inc. Change of Control Severance Plan, (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's 8-K (File no. 001-33332), filed on July 14, 2008 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.16
Amendment No. 2 to WABCO Holdings Inc. Change of Control Severance Plan, effective as of December 31, 2008 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.14 to the Company's Form 10-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on February 24, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.17
Amendment No. 3 to WABCO Holdings Inc. Change of Control Severance Plan, effective as of January 1, 2012.*
 
 
10.18
WABCO Holdings Inc. Deferred Compensation Plan (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's Form S-8 (File No. 333-148972), filed on January 31, 2008 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.19
Amendment to WABCO Holdings Inc. Deferred Compensation Plan, effective as of December 31, 2008 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.16 to the Company's Form 10-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on February 24, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.20
WABCO Holdings Inc. Supplemental Savings Plan (previously filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.21
Amendment to WABCO Holdings Inc. Supplemental Savings Plan, effective as of December 31, 2008 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.18 to the Company's Form 10-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on February 24, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.22
Employment Agreement by and between WABCO Expats Inc. and Jacques Esculier, dated as of July 27, 2007 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.12 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.23
Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation Program for Belgian Executives (Summary of French Language Program Document) (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on May 7, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 

80

Table of Contents

10.24
Amendment to Employment Agreement, by and between WABCO Expats Inc. and Jacques Esculier, dated December 31, 2008 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.20 to the Company's Form 10-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on February 24, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.25
Amendment to Employment Contract of March 1, 2003 by and between Trane Europe BVBA and Ulrich Michel, dated July 27, 2007 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.13 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.26
Amended Employment Agreement of Ulrich Michel, dated May 27, 2008 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's Form 8-K (File no. 001-33332), filed on June 6, 2008 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.27
Employment Agreement by and between WABCO Expats Inc. and Alfred Farha, dated April 25, 2008 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.7 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on August 8, 2008 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.28
Amendment to Employment Agreement, by and between WABCO Expats Inc. and Alfred Farha, dated December 31, 2008 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.24 to the Company's Form 10-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on February 24, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.29
Employment Agreement by and between WABCO Expats Inc. and Kevin Tarrant, dated as of July 1, 2007 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.14 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.30
Amendment to Employment Agreement, by and between WABCO Expats Inc. and Kevin Tarrant, dated December 31, 2008 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.26 to the Company's Form 10-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on February 24, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.31
Employment Agreement by and between World Standard Ltd. And Nikhil M. Varty, dated April 15, 2001 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.15 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.32
Addendum to Employment Agreement by and between World Standard Ltd. and Nikhil M. Varty, dated February 1, 2006 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.16 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.33
Amendment to the Employment Agreement of Nikhil Varty (previously filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on July 28, 2011 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.34
Employment Agreement by and between Trane Europe BVBA and Jean-Christophe Figueroa, dated January 21, 2005 (previously filed as Exhibit 10.17 to the Company's Form 10-Q (File No. 001-33332), filed on November 8, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.35
Partnership Agreement, dated as of January 9, 1990, as amended by Amendment No. 1 thereto, dated as of May 29, 1990, and Amendment No. 2 thereto, dated as of May 10, 2006, of Meritor WABCO Vehicle Control Systems (formerly known as Rockwell WABCO Vehicle Control Systems), by and between WABCO Automotive Control Systems, Inc. and ArvinMeritor Brake Holdings, Inc. (successor in interest to Rockwell Brake Systems, Inc.) (previously filed as Exhibit 10.5 to the Company's Form 10 (File No. 001-33332), filed on May 23, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.36
German Receivables Purchase and Servicing Agreement dated September 23, 2009, among WABCO Fahrzeugsysteme GmbH, as German Seller and German Servicer, WABCO Financial Services SPRL, as Seller's Agent, and Société Générale Bank Nederland N.V., as Purchaser (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on September 28, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.37
Italian Receivables Purchase and Servicing Agreement dated September 23, 2009, among WABCO Automotive Italia SRL, as Italian Seller and Italian Servicer, WABCO Financial Services SPRL, as Seller's Agent, and Société Générale Bank Nederland N.V., as Purchaser (previously filed as Exhibit 10.2 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on September 28, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).

81

Table of Contents

 
 
10.38
French Receivables Purchase and Servicing Agreement dated September 23, 2009, among WABCO Financial Services SPRL, as Seller's Agent, WABCO France S.A.S., as French Seller, Paris Titrisation, as Management Company, and Société Générale, as Custodian (previously filed as Exhibit 10.3 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on September 28, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.39
Master Definitions Agreement dated September 23, 2009, among Société Générale Bank Nederland N.V., as Senior Units Subscriber, the Bank or the Purchaser, as applicable, Paris Titrisation, as Management Company acting for the account of FCT Val Duchesse-Titrisation, Société Générale, as the Administrative Agent or Custodian, as applicable, Antalis S.A., WABCO France S.A.S., as French Seller, WABCO Fahrzeugsysteme GmbH, as German Seller, WABCO Automotive Italia SRL, as Italian Seller, WABCO Financial Services SPRL, as Depositor and the Seller's Agent, and WABCO Europe SPRL, as Insurance Servicer (previously filed as Exhibit 10.4 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on September 28, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.40
Guarantee and Subordination Agreement dated September 23, 2009, among WABCO Holdings Inc., as Guarantor, Paris Titrisation, as Management Company, Société Générale, as Custodian and Société Générale Bank Nederland N.V., as Purchaser (previously filed as Exhibit 10.5 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on September 28, 2009 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.41
$400,000,000 Facility Agreement, dated July 8, 2011, for WABCO Holdings Inc. arranged by Banc of America Securities Limited, Citigroup Global Markets Limited, Fortis Bank S.A./N.V., ING Belgium SN/NV, Societe Generale Corporate & Investment Banking, The Bank of Tokyo-Mitsubishi UFJ, LTD., The Royal Bank of Scotland NV, (Belgium) Branch, and Credit Lyonnais and Unicredit Bank AG, with Banc of America Securities Limited acting as agent (previously filed as Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's Form 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on July 11, 2011 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
10.42
Business Manager Contract, effective January 1, 2012 dated December 19, 2011 , by and between the Company and Jacques Esculier.*
 
 
10.43
Business Manager Contract, effective January 1, 2012 dated December 19, 2011 , by and between the Company and Nikhil Varty.*
 
 
10.44
Business Manager Contract, effective January 1, 2012 dated December 19, 2011 , by and between the Company and Kevin Tarrant.*
 
 
10.45
Business Manager Contract, effective January 1, 2012 dated December 19, 2011 , by and between the Company and Ulrich Michel.*
 
 
10.46
Business Manager Contract, effective January 1, 2012 dated December 19, 2011 , by and between the Company and Jean-Christophe Figueroa.*
 
 
16.1
Letter from Ernst & Young LLP dated August 2, 2007 (previously filed as Exhibit 16.1 to the Company's 8-K (File No. 001-33332), filed on August 2, 2007 and herein incorporated by reference).
 
 
21.1
Subsidiaries of the Company.
 
 
23.1
Consent of Ernst & Young Bedrijfsrevisoren BCVBA/Réviseurs d'Entreprises SCCRL.
 
 
24.1
Form of Power of Attorney (James F. Hardymon, G. Peter D'Aloia, John F. Fiedler, Dr. Juergen Gromer, Kenneth J. Martin, Mary Petrovich, Michael T. Smith and Donald J. Stebbins).
 
 
31.1
Certification of the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 
31.2
Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 
32.1
Certification of the Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 

82

Table of Contents

32.2
Certification of the Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.
 
 
101
The following financial information from WABCO Holdings, Inc.'s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2011, filed with the SEC on February 17, 2012, formatted in Extensible Business Reporting Language (XBRL): (i) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 2011 2010 and 2009, (ii) the Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheet at December 31, 2011 and 2010, (iii) the Condensed Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, and (iv) Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. +
+ Pursuant to Rule 406T of Regulation S-T, the XBRL related information in Exhibit 101 to this Annual Report on Form 10-K shall not be deemed to be “filed” for purposes of Section 18 of the Exchange Act, or otherwise subject to the liability of that section, and shall not be deemed part of a registration statement, prospectus or other document filed under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, except as shall be expressly set forth by specific reference in such filings

 


83


AMENDMENT NO. 2
TO
WABCO HOLDINGS INC. OMNIBUS INCENTIVE PLAN

WHEREAS , WABCO Holdings Inc. (the “Company”) adopted the WABCO Holdings Inc. Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “Plan”);

WHEREAS , under Section 11 of the Plan, the Board of Directors of the Company (the “Board”) has the authority to amend the Plan; and

WHEREAS , the Compensation, Governance and Nominating Committee of the Board, as the administrator of the Plan, has determined that it is in the best interest of the Company and its shareholders to amend the Plan on the terms set forth herein.

NOW, THEREFORE, the Plan shall be amended as follows, effective as of January 1, 2012:
1.
Section 1 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “Employees” in such Section:
“or independent business managers”

2.
Section 2.1(g)(i) of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “Employees” in such Section:
“or independent business managers”

3.
Section 4.1 of the Plan shall be amended to delete the last sentence of such Section in its entirety and replacing it with the following:
“Notwithstanding anything else contained in the Plan to the contrary, the Committee may delegate, subject to such terms and conditions or guidelines as it shall determine, to any employee or independent business manager of the Company or to a committee of employees or independent business managers of the Company any portion of its authority and powers under the Plan with respect to Participants who are not Executive Officers.”

4.
Section 4.3 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “employed” in such Section:
“or performing services”

5.
Section 4.5 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “employees” in such Section:
“, independent business managers”

6.
Section 6 of the Plan shall be amended by adding the following Section 6.11 at the end thereof:
“6.11 Change to Independent Business Manager . If an Employee becomes an independent business manager, he or she shall not experience a termination of employment for purposes of the Plan.”

7.
Section 12.6 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “employees” in such Section:
“or independent business managers”

8.
Section 12.9 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “Employee's” in such Section:





“or independent business manager's”

9.
Section 12.12 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the words “independent contractor”
“(including, for the avoidance of doubt, an independent business manager)”

10.
All other terms of the Plan shall remain in full force and effect.

IN WITNESS THEREOF , the Company has caused its name to be signed by its duly authorized officers as of the date first written above.


WABCO HOLDINGS INC.
                        
By: ________________________
                    
Name: Kevin Tarrant __________

Title: Chief Human Resources Officer





AMENDMENT NO. 1
TO
WABCO HOLDINGS INC. 2009 OMNIBUS INCENTIVE PLAN

WHEREAS , WABCO Holdings Inc. (the “Company”) adopted the WABCO Holdings Inc. 2009 Omnibus Incentive Plan (the “Plan”);

WHEREAS , under Section 11 of the Plan, the Board of Directors of the Company (the “Board”) has the authority to amend the Plan; and

WHEREAS , the Compensation, Governance and Nominating Committee of the Board, as the administrator of the Plan, has determined that it is in the best interest of the Company and its shareholders to amend the Plan on the terms set forth herein.

NOW, THEREFORE, the Plan shall be amended as follows, effective as of January 1, 2012:
1.
Section 1 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “Employees” in such Section:
“or independent business managers”

2.
Section 2.1(g)(i) of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “Employees” in such Section:
“or independent business managers”

3.
Section 4.1 of the Plan shall be amended to delete the last sentence of such Section in its entirety and replacing it with the following:
“Notwithstanding anything else contained in the Plan to the contrary, the Committee may delegate, subject to such terms and conditions or guidelines as it shall determine, to any employee or independent business manager of the Company or to a committee of employees or independent business managers of the Company any portion of its authority and powers under the Plan with respect to Participants who are not Executive Officers.”

4.
Section 4.3 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “employed” in such Section:
“or performing services”

5.
Section 4.5 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “employees” in such Section:
“, independent business managers”

6.
Section 6 of the Plan shall be amended by adding the following Section 6.11 at the end thereof:
“6.11 Change to Independent Business Manager . If an Employee becomes an independent business manager, he or she shall not experience a termination of employment for purposes of the Plan.”

7.
Section 12.6 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “employees” in such Section:
“or independent business managers”

8.
Section 12.9 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the word “Employee's” in such Section:





“or independent business manager's”

9.
Section 12.12 of the Plan shall be amended to add the following after the words “independent contractor”
“(including, for the avoidance of doubt, an independent business manager)”

10.
All other terms of the Plan shall remain in full force and effect.

IN WITNESS THEREOF , the Company has caused its name to be signed by its duly authorized officers as of the date first written above.


WABCO HOLDINGS INC.
                        
By: ________________________
                    
Name: Kevin Tarrant __________

Title: Chief Human Resources Officer






AMENDMENT NO. 3
TO
WABCO HOLDINGS INC. CHANGE OF CONTROL SEVERANCE PLAN

WHEREAS , WABCO Holdings Inc. (the “Company”) adopted the WABCO Holdings Inc. Change of Control Severance Plan (the “Plan”);

WHEREAS , under Section X of the Plan, the Company reserves the right to amend the Plan; and

WHEREAS , the Compensation, Governance and Nominating Committee of the Board of Directors of the Company, as the administrator of the Plan, has determined that it is in the best interest of the Company and its shareholders to amend the Plan on the terms set forth herein.

NOW, THEREFORE, the Plan shall be amended as follows, effective as of January 1, 2012:
1.
Section II of the Plan shall be amended to add the following sentence after the first sentence of subsection (E) (“ Cause” ) thereof:
“For avoidance of doubt, termination of a business manager who is party to a management agreement other than for the reasons listed above shall in no event be “Cause” for termination under the Plan.”

2.
Section II of the Plan shall be amended to add the words “or services” immediately after each instance in which the word “employment” appears in subsection (M) (“ Good Reason ”).
3.
Section II of the Plan shall be amended to add the following sentence to the end of subsection (N) (“ Participant ”) of such Section:
“An independent contractor serving as a business manager of the Company or a Subsidiary shall be a “Participant” for purposes of the Plan.”

4.
Section III of the Plan shall be amended to add the following sentence at the end thereof:
“In the case of an independent contractor who is a business manager, termination of such person's management agreement shall be treated as a termination of employment.”

5.
Section IX of the Plan shall be amended by deleting the heading “Certain Additional Payments” and replacing it with the heading “Certain Limitations on Payments”.
6.
Section IX of the Plan shall be further amended by deleting such Section in its entirety and replacing it with the following:
“A. If any amounts due to the Participant under the Plan and any other plan or program of the Company or its respective affiliates with respect to any services constitute a "parachute payment," as such term is defined in Section 280G(b)(2) of the Code, then the aggregate of the amounts constituting the parachute payment shall be reduced such that the aggregate “present value” of such amounts at all times is not greater than three times the “base amount” less one dollar (the “Golden Parachute Limit”); provided, however, that if the total after-tax payments that the Participant would receive under the Plan and any other plan or program of the Company or its respective affiliates with respect to any services if the Golden Parachute Limit were exceeded is greater than the total after-tax payments the Participant would receive if the amounts were reduced as described above, such amounts shall not be reduced. For purposes of applying the Golden Parachute Limit, the definitions and rules set forth in the Treasury Regulations promulgated under Section 280G of the Code shall apply.

B.      All determinations under the preceding paragraph shall be made by a nationally recognized





accounting, executive compensation or law firm appointed by the Company (the “Consultant”) that is acceptable to the Participant on the basis of “substantial authority” (within the meaning of Section 6662 of the Code). The Consultant's fee shall be paid by the Company. The Consultant shall provide a report to the Participant that may be used by the Participant to file the Participant's tax returns.

C.      It is possible that payments will be made by the Company which should not have been made (each, an “Overpayment”) due to the uncertain application of Section 280G of the Code at the time of a determination hereunder. In the event that there is a final determination by the Internal Revenue Service, or a final determination by a court of competent jurisdiction, that an Overpayment has been made, any such Overpayment shall be repaid by the Participant to the Company together with interest at the prime rate of interest in effect on the date of such Overpayment; provided, however, that no amount shall be payable by a Participant to the Company if and to the extent such payment would not reduce the amount which is subject to taxation under Section 4999 of the Code.”

7.
Section XII of the Plan shall be amended by deleting the final sentence thereof in its entirety and replacing it with the following:
“Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, all payments and benefits which are payable upon a termination of employment or termination of business manager status hereunder shall be paid or provided only upon those terminations of employment or business manager status that constitute a “separation from service” from the Company within the meaning of Section 409A of the Code (determined after applying the presumptions set forth in Treas. Reg. Section 1.409A-1(h)(1))”

8.
All other terms of the Plan shall remain in full force and effect.

IN WITNESS THEREOF , the Company has caused its name to be signed by its duly authorized officers as of the date first written above.


WABCO HOLDINGS INC.
                        
By: ________________________
                    
Name: Kevin Tarrant __________

Title: Chief Human Resources Officer







MANAGEMENT AGREEMENT



BETWEEN:

WABCO Europe SPRL/BVBA , having its registered offices at 1160 Brussels, Chaussée de Wavre/Waversesteenweg 1789, with company number 0475.956.135;

Hereinafter referred to as “the Company”;

Represented for the purposes of the Agreement by Mr. Ulrich Michel and Mr. Jozef Van Osta in their capacity of Business Manager of the Company;


AND:

Mr. Jacques Esculier , residing at

Hereinafter referred to as “the Business Manager”;


TAKING INTO ACCOUNT THE FOLLOWING;


WHEREAS the Company undertakes and warrants that the Business Manager will be appointed as a remunerated general manager of the Company by its General Assembly of Shareholders with effect as of January 1, 2012;

WHEREAS the Company and the Business Manager wish to determine in a written agreement (“the Agreement”) the terms and conditions under which the latter will perform the office as business manager of the Company effective as of January 1, 2012 (the “Effective Date”);


IT HAS BEEN AGREED AS FOLLOWS :

Article 1 - Object of the agreement

1.
The Business Manager agrees to perform the office of business manager of the Company. In his capacity of business manager, he will manage the Company subject to the terms and conditions of the Agreement.

2.
Pursuant to generally applicable management practice, the Business Manager will attend all meetings of the Board of Business Managers and through his contribution and effort as business manager provide together with the other business managers the best possible management for the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will at all times respect and abide the division of decision and representation powers for business managers as established by the Shareholder's meeting in the articles of association as well as any other Company policy which may affect him as a business manager of the Company.

1.
The Board of Business Managers may delegate special powers to the Business Manager within the framework of his office as business manager, and the Business Manager will carry them out to the best of his abilities.


Article 2 - The conditions of the agreement

1.
The Business Manager shall perform the Agreement on a self-employed basis.






2.
The Business Manager will be available for the performance of the Agreement during the time considered necessary in order to fulfill his obligations resulting from this agreement. To that effect, the Business Manager accepts to be available during regular office hours and to perform 225 man-days per calendar year.

Prior to the beginning of the Agreement and during the performance thereof, the Business Manager will inform the Company in writing of any other positions (whether remunerated or not) which he holds in any other company or association. The Company has the right to request the Business Manager terminate such positions to the extent that they could possibly hinder the proper performance of the Agreement.

In addition, the Business Manager will refrain from accepting any position (whether remunerated or not) in any other company or association which might conflict with the proper performance of the Agreement, except with the prior written consent of the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will be provided with the necessary infrastructure, logistical support and documentation of the Company insofar as it is necessary for the proper performance of the Agreement.

4.
As holder of a corporate mandate, the Business Manager agrees to respect all instructions in relation to safety and health, which are applicable within the premises of the Company where personnel are working. The Business Manager explicitly allows the Company to take the necessary measures in his name in the event any problem would arise in this respect.

6.
The Business Manager shall perform his office as business manager of the Company as a normal prudent business manager, with due diligence and in accordance with generally accepted and consistently applied business practices. The Business Manager shall, at all times, (a) take into consideration the objectives and best interest of the Company and the WABCO group in general, (b) comply with all applicable laws and regulations and (c) comply with all corporate policies and codes of business ethics established by the Company or the WABCO group in general, including but not necessarily limited to global policies relating to technology, operations, human resources, finance, and proposal and contract approvals.

7.
The Business manager will be covered by the WABCO Director and Officers Policy, covering the liability of company directors and officers.


Article 3 - Place of performance and mobility

1.
The Business Manager agrees to fulfill his duties and responsibilities under this Agreement from the business premises of the Company in Belgium.

2.
In view of the international scope of activities and business of the Company, the Business Manager acknowledges and accepts that proper performance of the mandate may require that he travels to other locations abroad and performs temporary assignments abroad at any time.


Article 4 - Base salary

1.
For the duration of the Agreement, the Company will pay the Business Manager a fixed annual remuneration of 769,231 EUR gross (hereinafter referred to as “the Base Salary”). The Base Salary shall be paid in 12 equal monthly installments per month performed, after deduction of the tax and any other contractual withholdings. In case of an incomplete year, the Base Salary shall be paid pro rata temporis.

2.
The Base Salary will be reviewed once a year, it being understood that such adjustment must be endorsed by the competent corporate body of the Company. The adjustment of the Base Salary will take effect as of the month of July.







Article 5 - Incentives

1.
The Business Manager is eligible to participate in the Annual Incentive Plan (AIP) of the Company in accordance with rules and conditions of such plan which is subject to change from time to time. The Business Manager's individual AIP target (“the AIP Target”) amounts to 100% of the Base Salary. The actual AIP payment (“the Actual AIP”) is based on the achievement of individual and company performance goals which are determined every performance year by the Compensation Nominating and Governance committee (“the CNG Committee”) of the Board of directors.


2.
The Business Manager is eligible to participate in the Cash Long Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) of the Company in accordance with rules and conditions of such plan which is subject to change from time to time. The target LTIP (“the LTIP Target”) amounts to 100% of the average Base Salary over the three year cycle period. The actual LTIP payment (“the Actual LTIP”) is based on the achievement of company performance goals which are determined for each cycle by the CNG Committee.

3.
The Business Manager will be eligible for an annual equity grant based on the CNG Committee's annual recommendation and in accordance with the provisions of the WABCO Omnibus Incentive Plan which is subject to change from time to time. The grant may consist of stock options and/or restricted stock awards or units or any other equity benefits.

Article 6 - Company car

1.
The Company shall provide the Business Manager with the use of a car and fuel card, pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Company's car policy which is subject to change from time to time. All costs associated with the use of the car shall be borne by the Company.

2.
The Business Manager can also make use of the company car for private purposes. The private use of the company car will be taxed as a benefit in kind in accordance with the official guidelines of the tax authorities. The Business Manager accepts that the taxation of the private use can change due to a modification of the legal rules of such a benefit.


Article 7 - Other benefits

The Company shall provide the Business Manager with the following benefits:
the use of a mobile phone, pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Company's mobile phone policy which is subject to change from time to time;
the use of a laptop.

Article 8 - Insurances

1.
The Business Manager will be covered by the company group insurance plan for its business managers, which is subject to change from time to time. The insurance plan covers extra-legal pension, death in service, invalidity and guaranteed income.

The Business Manager explicitly agrees that all personal contributions of the Business Manager will be deducted from his monthly salary.

A summary of the company group insurance plan is attached as Annex 1 to the Agreement.


2 .
Medical care will be covered by a private medical insurance concluded by the Company for the business manager and his dependent family members.






3.
If the Business Manager is unable to perform his duties and obligation through illness or inability to work, the Business Manager will be entitled to receive his Base Salary during the first month of illness or inability to work. After the initial period of 30 or 31 consecutive days the company group insurance plan defined in article 8 of the present agreement applies. This will be subject to the production of medical certificates and to such other requirement as the Company, as well as the insurance company may reasonably impose.

Article 9 - Expenses


1.
The Company will reimburse the Business Manager all professional costs he may incur in the normal execution of the Agreement provided they are reasonable and justified through expense reports.

Article 10 - Goods and services differential

1.
According to the Company's international mobility policy and when applicable, the Company used to compensate expatriates for cost of living differences between residing in the United States and Brussels, Belgium through the payment of a goods and services differential. Any such adjustment was based on average expenditures by income group and family size as established by an independent research service selected by the Company.

2.
Parties agree that the application of the goods and services differential will be fixed at the fourth quarter of 2011 differential i.e USD 141,182 or EUR 108,602 and will be phased-out during a three-year period starting as of January 2012 with the following percentages:

for the calendar year 2012: 100 % of the differential will be awarded;
for the calendar year 2013: 67 % of the differential will be awarded;
for the calendar year 2014: 33 % of the differential will be awarded;
as of calendar year 2015: no differential anymore.

Article 11 - Housing &Home Leave

1.
The Company will pay to the Business Manager a monthly net housing allowance of EUR 5,390 to be indexed on an annual basis based on rent indexes in Belgium. The Company will also reimburse for house utilities, including gas, water, electricity and maintenance.

2.
Home leave will be provided annually for the Business Manager and his family. Only transportation to and from home is provided.

Article 12 - Taxes
1.
The Company will notify the Belgian tax authorities on behalf of the Business Manager about the change of the status of the Business Manager in order to obtain a continuation of the special tax status for expatriates.

1.
The Business Manager will not undertake any action that could jeopardize the continued application of the special tax status for expatriates or reduce the benefits for the Company.

3.
The Business Manager shall provide to the Company or the Company's designated tax advisors all documents related to his professional travel outside Belgium, such as boarding passes, train tickets, visa stubs, etc.

4.
The Company will provide the Business Manager with tax assistance with regard to his Belgian income tax return at the Company's expense.

5.
As the Business Manager has the fiscal status of manager ('bedrijfsleider'/'dirigeant d'entreprise') for Belgian income tax purposes, the Company will deduct withholding taxes from the Business Manager's remuneration.






6.
The Business Manager understands and acknowledges that as of the start of the business manager status, he will be responsible for paying actual income taxes in Belgium. According to the company tax policy for business managers, the Company will however bear the actual income taxes in the United States, if any, under the applicable tax equalization policy for business managers as attached as annex 2 to the agreement.

7.
Stock options that have been granted in the past when the Business Manager was subject to tax equalization (whereby a hypothetical tax was calculated and deducted on the professional income taking into account the tax rules of the home country being the US), will be treated as follows:

Upon exercise, an amount will be withheld from the exercise gain, being the lesser of:

the Belgian income tax paid upon grant (including any tax payable at another moment within the rules of the specific Belgian legislation of March 26, 1999 on stock options) OR the Belgian income tax payable at exercise (if no taxation should have taken place at grant); AND
the hypothetical tax that would have been due under the conditions of the previous tax equalization agreement.

Article 13 - School allowance

1.
The Company will reimburse the Business Manager for the education costs of his dependent children in grades K to 12 (or up to the end of secondary school). Reimbursement under this provision shall be limited to tuition fees, books and necessary supplies, and local transportation.


Article 14 - Social security

1.
The Business Manager will be subject to the Belgian social security scheme for self-employed workers, in accordance with the Belgian social security legislation.

The Business Manager will be solely liable for his personal social security obligations in relation to the performance of the Agreement. The Business Manager will register with a Belgian social insurance fund for self-employed workers. The Company will pay on behalf of the Business Manager the required quarterly social security contributions to the social insurance fund in order to keep their affiliation with the Belgian social security scheme for self-employed workers.

The Business Manager explicitly agrees that all payments made by the Company on behalf of the Business Manager will be deducted from his monthly salary.


Article 15 - Confidentiality

1.
All information, data, written materials, discs, files, software and/or any other document and/or material prepared for the benefit of or received by the Business Manager in execution of or during the performance of the Agreement and connected to the business of the Company, its clients and/or its personnel is qualified as confidential information (hereinafter referred to as “Confidential Information”) and will remain exclusively the property of the Company.

2.
At the moment of the effective termination of the Agreement, for whatever reason, or at the sole request of the Company during the performance of the Agreement, the Business Manager will immediately transfer all Confidential Information to the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will not be entitled to take or keep any transcript or copy of the Confidential Information, under whatever form, after the termination of the Agreement. All possible titles and/or intellectual rights that may





be connected directly or indirectly with the Confidential Information belong to the Company and remain the sole property of the latter.

4.
Furthermore, the Business Manager will not reveal any Confidential Information to third parties and/or use this information on his own behalf or jointly with or on behalf of any person, firm or company after the termination of the Agreement for whatever reason.

5.
The present section does not apply with regard to information pertaining to the public domain.


Article 16 - Intellectual property

1.
All systems, programs, software (object codes as well as source codes), documents, databases, manuals, reports, trade secrets, inventions, improvements, know-how and all other work created, designed, developed or produced by the Business Manager, whether or not by using the facilities of the Company, in the course of or in relation with the performance of this Management Agreement, or that relate to the activities of the Company (the “Works”) shall remain or become the exclusive property of the Company. This exclusivity implies but is not limited to the transfer and assignment of all intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works to the Company.

2.
All intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works (including but not limited to copyrights, trademark rights, rights on databases, rights on computer programs as well as patent rights) that have come into existence or will come into existence in the course of or in relation with the performance of the Agreement are immediately transferred and assigned to the Company as from their coming into existence or, as from the execution of this Management Agreement for rights already in existence at the time of contracting.

3.
The transfer and assignment of these intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works includes, but is not limited to the transfer and assignment of the right to reproduce, modify, translate, adapt, use to make derivative works, distribute, rent, lend and/or communicate the Works to the public, partially or completely, in each and any way, for internal (including but not limited to research and development) and external use. The transfer and assignment is valid for all countries, in the most extensive way possible as permitted by law, without limitation in time other than the legal duration of validity of these rights and without further payment than the fee as provided for executing the Agreement.

4.
The Business Manager undertakes to fully inform the Company, upon first demand of the Company, that it has created, designed, developed or produced certain Works. The Business Manager undertakes to fully communicate all information and know-how in relation to the Works to the Company, and this immediately upon the creation, design, development or production of the Works.

5.
Should the Company decide, without having any obligations whatsoever, to file for any registered intellectual property rights in relation to a Work, the Business Manager undertakes, upon first demand of the Company, upon expenses borne by the Company, to provide all necessary or useful cooperation and to provide and sign all documents in order to permit, facilitate or accelerate any application for any registered intellectual property right. The Business Manager undertakes not to apply for any registered intellectual property right or to ask a third party to apply for a registered intellectual property right related to the Works without the written express authorization of the Company.

6.
The Company has the exclusive right to decide, when and how, to exploit the Works. Works that have not been exploited remain the exclusive property of the Company. The Company can adapt and modify the Works as it deems appropriate in order to exploit the Works. The Business Manager agrees not to oppose the adaptation or the modification of the Works. The Business Manager agrees that the Company may exploit the Works without mentioning the Business Manager's name.
     








Article 17 - Duration / Termination

1.
The Agreement shall enter into force on January 1, 2012, i.e. date of the Business Manager's appointment as business manager of the Company by the General Assembly of Shareholders of the Company.
2.
The Agreement is concluded for an indefinite duration .
3.
Except as provided in Article 18 , upon termination of the Business Manager's mandate by the General Assembly of Shareholders of the Company without Cause or by the Business manager for Good Reason (as these terms are defined in annex 3 to this Agreement), hence upon termination of the Agreement, the Company must pay the Business Manager a severance payment equal to two times the remuneration (as defined in paragraph 4 of this article 17).
However, if the Business Manager, in whatever function or capacity, accepts employment by or a collaboration agreement (including, for avoidance of doubt, a Business Management Agreement) with a company of the WABCO Group, this will not be considered as a termination of the Agreement by the Company in the framework of this article.
4.
Remuneration in the framework of the present article consists of the following elements:
a)
The Base Salary defined in article 4 of the Agreement;
b)
The AIP Target as defined in article 5.1. of the Agreement;
c)
Contributions for Group insurance and medical cover as defined in Article 8 of the Agreement
5.
Severance will however not be due if the Company terminates the Business Manager's mandate and hence the Agreement because of “Cause”.
6.
The Business manager will also be reimbursed for financial planning services of up to $5,000 for one year after the date of termination.
7.
The Business Manager will respect a reasonable notice period in case of resignation from his mandate. The reasonable notice period is three months in all cases, unless Parties agree otherwise. In case of resignation from his mandate by the Business Manager, the latter will not be entitled to the severance payment foreseen in article 17 . 3.
8.
The Business Manager will not be entitled to any severance under this Management Agreement unless:
A) he executes a release of claims against the Company and its affiliated companies in a form acceptable to the Company; OR
B) a final irrevocable court decision intervened on all existing claims (apart from the entitlement to the remainder of the contractual severance) and the Business Manager executed a release of claims against the Company and its affiliated companies in a form acceptable to the Company for all other claims that may exist at that time.
In this respect the company agrees to pay an advance to the severance pay equal to six months' severance and this within a timeframe of 45 days after the termination of the contract.

Article 18 - Change of control

1.
Any severance provided upon a “Change of Control” (as that term is defined in the WABCO Holdings Inc. Change of Control Severance Plan (the “Change of Control Plan”)) shall be provided pursuant to the terms of the Change of Control Plan. Any such payment shall be in lieu of any severance payment that might be payable under article 17 or otherwise


Article 19 - Notification

Any notification in connection with the Agreement must be made in writing and in English and shall be validly given with respect to each party if sent by registered mail or courier to the addresses set out in the beginning of this Management Agreement or to such other address as a party may notify to the other in accordance with this clause.






Article 20 - Section 409A

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the Agreement, in the event that the Business Manager is or becomes a U.S. citizen or resident alien during the term of the Agreement, the special payment provisions to comply with Section 409A of the Code that are set forth in annex 4 shall apply.


Article 21 - Enforceability

Any provision of the Agreement or part thereof which would be declared null and void, will be considered separated from the Agreement, which, for the remainder, will remain applicable.


Article 22 - Applicable law / Jurisdiction

1.
The Agreement is governed by Belgian law and any dispute concerning the interpretation, performance and/or termination of the Agreement must be resolved under Belgian law.
2.
The courts of Brussels have exclusive authority in relation to every dispute connected to the interpretation, the performance and/or the termination of the Agreement. By executing the Agreement, the Business Manager consents to the jurisdiction of the Belgian courts with respect to the Agreement.


Article 23 - Entire agreement

1.
The Agreement constitutes the entire agreement existing between parties, with respect to services performed hereunder during periods on and after the Effective Date. It replaces every other agreement and/or arrangement between parties to the extent that its provisions are incompatible with the provisions of the Agreement.
2.
All policies referred to in the Agreement, whether attached to this agreement as an annex or not, form an integral part of the Agreement and have the same legal value.

Established in two original copies in Brussels on December 19, 2011, both parties acknowledging receipt of one original copy duly signed by the other parties.

The Business Manager                          For the Company,
Jacques Esculier                          Ulrich Michel
(“ read and approved ”)                          Business Manager



__________                              __________
[ signature* ]                              [ signature ]

Jozef Van Osta
Business Manager

                                
__________
[ signature ]







MANAGEMENT AGREEMENT



BETWEEN:

WABCO Europe SPRL/BVBA , having its registered offices at 1160 Brussels, Chaussée de Wavre/Waversesteenweg 1789, with company number 0475.956.135;

Hereinafter referred to as “the Company”;

Represented for the purposes of the Agreement by Mr. Jacques Esculier and Mr. Ulrich Michel in their capacity of Business Manager of the Company;


AND:

Mr. Nikhil Varty , residing at

Hereinafter referred to as “the Business Manager”;


TAKING INTO ACCOUNT THE FOLLOWING;


WHEREAS the Company undertakes and warrants that the Business Manager will be appointed as a remunerated general manager of the Company by its General Assembly of Shareholders with effect as of January 1, 2012;

WHEREAS the Company and the Business Manager wish to determine in a written agreement (“the Agreement”) the terms and conditions under which the latter will perform the office as business manager of the Company effective as of January 1, 2012 (the “Effective Date”);


IT HAS BEEN AGREED AS FOLLOWS :

Article 1 - Object of the agreement

1.
The Business Manager agrees to perform the office of business manager of the Company. In his capacity of business manager, he will manage the Company subject to the terms and conditions of the Agreement.

2.
Pursuant to generally applicable management practice, the Business Manager will attend all meetings of the Board of Business Managers and through his contribution and effort as business manager provide together with the other business managers the best possible management for the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will at all times respect and abide the division of decision and representation powers for business managers as established by the Shareholder's meeting in the articles of association as well as any other Company policy which may affect him as a business manager of the Company.

1.
The Board of Business Managers may delegate special powers to the Business Manager within the framework of his office as business manager, and the Business Manager will carry them out to the best of his abilities.


Article 2 - The conditions of the agreement

1.
The Business Manager shall perform the Agreement on a self-employed basis.






2.
The Business Manager will be available for the performance of the Agreement during the time considered necessary in order to fulfill his obligations resulting from this agreement. To that effect, the Business Manager accepts to be available during regular office hours and to perform 225 man-days per calendar year.

Prior to the beginning of the Agreement and during the performance thereof, the Business Manager will inform the Company in writing of any other positions (whether remunerated or not) which he holds in any other company or association. The Company has the right to request the Business Manager terminate such positions to the extent that they could possibly hinder the proper performance of the Agreement.

In addition, the Business Manager will refrain from accepting any position (whether remunerated or not) in any other company or association which might conflict with the proper performance of the Agreement, except with the prior written consent of the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will be provided with the necessary infrastructure, logistical support and documentation of the Company insofar as it is necessary for the proper performance of the Agreement.

4.
As holder of a corporate mandate, the Business Manager agrees to respect all instructions in relation to safety and health, which are applicable within the premises of the Company where personnel are working. The Business Manager explicitly allows the Company to take the necessary measures in his name in the event any problem would arise in this respect.

5.
The Business Manager shall report to the Chairman of the Board of Business Managers on the progress of his activities at the moments determined by the Board of Business Managers of the Company, its Chairman or whenever the parties to the Agreement consider it to be necessary.

6.
The Business Manager shall perform his office as business manager of the Company as a normal prudent business manager, with due diligence and in accordance with generally accepted and consistently applied business practices. The Business Manager shall, at all times, (a) take into consideration the objectives and best interest of the Company and the WABCO group in general, (b) comply with all applicable laws and regulations and (c) comply with all corporate policies and codes of business ethics established by the Company or the WABCO group in general, including but not necessarily limited to global policies relating to technology, operations, human resources, finance, and proposal and contract approvals.

7.
The Business manager will be covered by the WABCO Director and Officers Policy, covering the liability of company directors and officers.


Article 3 - Place of performance and mobility

1.
The Business Manager agrees to fulfill his duties and responsibilities under this Agreement from the business premises of the Company in Belgium.

2.
In view of the international scope of activities and business of the Company, the Business Manager acknowledges and accepts that proper performance of the mandate may require that he travel to other locations abroad and performs temporary assignments abroad at any time.


Article 4 - Base salary

1.
For the duration of the Agreement, the Company will pay the Business Manager a fixed annual remuneration of EUR 277,308 gross (hereinafter referred to as “the Base Salary”). The Base Salary shall be paid in 12 equal monthly installments per month performed, after deduction of the tax and any other contractual withholdings. In case of an incomplete year, the Base Salary shall be paid pro rata temporis.






2.
The Base Salary will be reviewed once a year, it being understood that such adjustment must be endorsed by the competent corporate body of the Company. The adjustment of the Base Salary will take effect as of the month of July.


Article 5 - Incentives

1.
The Business Manager is eligible to participate in the Annual Incentive Plan (AIP) of the Company in accordance with rules and conditions of such plan which is subject to change from time to time. The Business Manager's individual AIP target (“the AIP Target”) amounts to 60 % of the Base Salary. The actual AIP payment (“the Actual AIP”) is based on the achievement of individual and company performance goals which are determined every performance year by the Compensation Nominating and Governance (CNG) committee of the Board of directors.

2.
The Business Manager is eligible to participate in the Cash Long Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) of the Company in accordance with rules and conditions of such plan which is subject to change from time to time. The target LTIP (“the LTIP Target”) amounts to 45% of the average Base Salary over the three year cycle period. The actual LTIP payment (“the Actual LTIP”) is based on the achievement of company performance goals which are determined for each cycle by the CNG committee of the Board of directors.

3.
The Business Manager will be eligible for an annual equity grant based on the CNG committee's annual recommendation and in accordance with the provisions of the WABCO Omnibus Incentive Plan which is subject to change from time to time. The grant may consist of stock options and/or restricted stock awards or units or any other equity benefits.

Article 6 - Company car

1.
The Company shall provide the Business Manager with the use of a car and fuel card, pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Company's car policy which is subject to change from time to time. All costs associated with the use of the car shall be borne by the Company.

2.
The Business Manager can also make use of the company car for private purposes. The private use of the company car will be taxed as a benefit in kind in accordance with the official guidelines of the tax authorities. The Business Manager accepts that the taxation of the private use can change due to a modification of the legal rules of such a benefit.


Article 7 - Other benefits

The Company shall provide the Business Manager with the following benefits:
the use of a mobile phone, pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Company's mobile phone policy which is subject to change from time to time;
the use of a laptop.


Article 8 - Insurances

1.
The Business Manager will be covered by the company group insurance plan for its business managers, which is subject to change from time to time. The insurance plan covers extra-legal pension, death in service, invalidity and guaranteed income.

The Business Manager explicitly agrees that all personal contributions of the Business Manager will be deducted from his monthly salary.

A summary of the company group insurance plan is attached as Annex 1 to the Agreement.









2 .
Medical care will be covered through the Belgian social security scheme and a private medical insurance paid concluded by the Company for its business managers.

Article 9 - Expenses

1.
The Company will reimburse the Business Manager all professional costs he may incur in the normal execution of the Agreement provided they are reasonable and justified through expense reports.

Article 10 - Goods and services differential

1.
According to the Company's international mobility policy and when applicable, the Company used to compensate expatriates for cost of living differences between residing in the United States and Brussels, Belgium through the payment of a goods and services differential. Any such adjustment was based on average expenditures by income group and family size as established by an independent research service selected by the Company.

2.
Parties agree that the application of the goods and services differential will be fixed at the fourth quarter of 2011 differential i.e USD 42,523 or EUR 32,710 and will be phased-out during a three-year period starting as of January 2012 with the following percentages:

for the calendar year 2012: 100 % of the differential will be awarded;
for the calendar year 2013: 67 % of the differential will be awarded;
for the calendar year 2014: 33 % of the differential will be awarded;
as of calendar year 2015: no differential anymore.

Article 11 - Housing &Home Leave

1.
The Company will pay to the Business Manager a net monthly housing allowance of EUR 4,750 to be indexed on an annual basis based on rent indexes in Belgium. The Company will also reimburse for house utilities, including gas, water, electricity and maintenance.

2.
Home leave will be provided annually for the Business Manager and his family. Only transportation to and from home is provided.

Article 12 - Taxes

1.
The Company will notify the Belgian tax authorities on behalf of the Business Manager about the change of the status of the Business Manager in order to obtain a continuation of the special tax status for expatriates.

1.
The Business Manager will not undertake any action that could jeopardize the continued application of the special tax status for expatriates or reduce the benefits for the Company.

3.
The Business Manager shall provide to the Company or the Company's designated tax advisors all documents related to his professional travel outside Belgium, such as boarding passes, train tickets, visa stubs, etc.

4.
The Company will provide the Business Manager with tax assistance with regard to his Belgian income tax return at the Company's expense.

5.
As the Business Manager has the fiscal status of manager ('bedrijfsleider'/'dirigeant d'entreprise') for Belgian income tax purposes, the Company will deduct withholding taxes from the Business Manager's remuneration.

6.
The Business Manager understands and acknowledges that as of the start of the business manager status, he will





be responsible for paying actual income taxes in Belgium. According to the company tax policy for business managers, the Company will however bear the actual income taxes in the United States, if any, under the applicable tax equalization policy for business managers as attached as annex 2 to the agreement.


Article 13 - School allowance

1.
The Company will reimburse the Business Manager for the education costs of his dependent children in grades K to 12 (or up to the end of secondary school). Reimbursement under this provision shall be limited to tuition fees, books and necessary supplies, and local school transportation.


Article 14 - Social security

1.
The Business Manager will be subject to the Belgian social security scheme for self-employed workers, in accordance with the Belgian social security legislation.

The Business Manager will be solely liable for his personal social security obligations in relation to the performance of the Agreement. The Business Manager will register with a Belgian social insurance fund for self-employed workers. The Company will pay on behalf of the Business Manager the required quarterly social security contributions to the social insurance fund in order to keep their affiliation with the Belgian social security scheme for self-employed workers.

The Business Manager explicitly agrees that all payments made by the Company on behalf of the Business Manager will be deducted from his monthly salary.


Article 15 - Confidentiality

1.
All information, data, written materials, discs, files, software and/or any other document and/or material prepared for the benefit of or received by the Business Manager in execution of or during the performance of the Agreement and connected to the business of the Company, its clients and/or its personnel is qualified as confidential information (hereinafter referred to as “Confidential Information”) and will remain exclusively the property of the Company.

2.
At the moment of the effective termination of the Agreement, for whatever reason, or at the sole request of the Company during the performance of the Agreement, the Business Manager will immediately transfer all Confidential Information to the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will not be entitled to take or keep any transcript or copy of the Confidential Information, under whatever form, after the termination of the Agreement. All possible titles and/or intellectual rights that may be connected directly or indirectly with the Confidential Information belong to the Company and remain the sole property of the latter.

4.
Furthermore, the Business Manager will not reveal any Confidential Information to third parties and/or use this information on his own behalf or jointly with or on behalf of any person, firm or company after the termination of the Agreement for whatever reason.

5.
The present section does not apply with regard to information pertaining to the public domain.


Article 16 - Intellectual property






1.
All systems, programs, software (object codes as well as source codes), documents, databases, manuals, reports, trade secrets, inventions, improvements, know-how and all other work created, designed, developed or produced by the Business Manager, whether or not by using the facilities of the Company, in the course of or in relation with the performance of this Management Agreement, or that relate to the activities of the Company (the “Works”) shall remain or become the exclusive property of the Company. This exclusivity implies but is not limited to the transfer and assignment of all intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works to the Company.

2.
All intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works (including but not limited to copyrights, trademark rights, rights on databases, rights on computer programs as well as patent rights) that have come into existence or will come into existence in the course of or in relation with the performance of the Agreement are immediately transferred and assigned to the Company as from their coming into existence or, as from the execution of this Management Agreement for rights already in existence at the time of contracting.

3.
The transfer and assignment of these intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works includes, but is not limited to the transfer and assignment of the right to reproduce, modify, translate, adapt, use to make derivative works, distribute, rent, lend and/or communicate the Works to the public, partially or completely, in each and any way, for internal (including but not limited to research and development) and external use. The transfer and assignment is valid for all countries, in the most extensive way possible as permitted by law, without limitation in time other than the legal duration of validity of these rights and without further payment than the fee as provided for executing the Agreement.

4.
The Business Manager undertakes to fully inform the Company, upon first demand of the Company, that it has created, designed, developed or produced certain Works. The Business Manager undertakes to fully communicate all information and know-how in relation to the Works to the Company, and this immediately upon the creation, design, development or production of the Works.

5.
Should the Company decide, without having any obligations whatsoever, to file for any registered intellectual property rights in relation to a Work, the Business Manager undertakes, upon first demand of the Company, upon expenses borne by the Company, to provide all necessary or useful cooperation and to provide and sign all documents in order to permit, facilitate or accelerate any application for any registered intellectual property right. The Business Manager undertakes not to apply for any registered intellectual property right or to ask a third party to apply for a registered intellectual property right related to the Works without the written express authorisation of the Company.

6.
The Company has the exclusive right to decide, when and how, to exploit the Works. Works that have not been exploited remain the exclusive property of the Company. The Company can adapt and modify the Works as it deems appropriate in order to exploit the Works. The Business Manager agrees not to oppose the adaptation or the modification of the Works. The Business Manager agrees that the Company may exploit the Works without mentioning the Business Manager's name.
     
Article 17 - Duration / Termination

1.
The Agreement shall enter into force on January 1, 2012, i.e. date of the Business Manager's appointment as business manager of the Company by the General Assembly of Shareholders of the Company.
2.
The Agreement is concluded for an indefinite duration .
3.
Except as provided in Article 18 , upon termination of the Business Manager's mandate by the General Assembly of Shareholders of the Company without Cause or by the Business manager for Good Reason (as these terms are defined in annex 3 to this Agreement), hence upon termination of the Agreement, the Company must pay the Business Manager a severance payment equal to 1.5 times the remuneration (as defined in paragraph 4 of this article 17).
However, if the Business Manager, in whatever function or capacity, accepts employment by or a collaboration





agreement (including, for avoidance of doubt, a Business Management Agreement) with a company of the WABCO Group, this will not be considered as a termination of the Agreement by the Company in the framework of this article.
4.
Remuneration in the framework of the present article consists of the following elements:
a)
The Base Salary defined in article 4 of the Agreement;
b)
The AIP Target as defined in article 5.1. of the Agreement;
c)
Contributions for Group insurance and medical cover as defined in Article 8 of the Agreement
5.
Severance will however not be due if the Company terminates the Business Manager's mandate and hence the Agreement because of “Cause”.
6.
The Business manager will also be reimbursed for financial planning services of up to $5,000 for one year after the date of termination.
7.
The Business Manager will respect a reasonable notice period in case of resignation from his mandate. The reasonable notice period is three months in all cases, unless Parties agree otherwise. In case of resignation from his mandate by the Business Manager, the latter will not be entitled to the severance payment foreseen in article 17 .3.
8.
The Business Manager will not be entitled to any severance under this Management Agreement unless:
A) he executes a release of claims against the Company and its affiliated companies in a form acceptable to the Company; OR
B) a final irrevocable court decision intervened on all existing claims (apart from the entitlement to the remainder of the contractual severance) and the Business Manager executed a release of claims against the Company and its affiliated companies in a form acceptable to the Company for all other claims that may exist at that time.
In this respect the company agrees to pay an advance to the severance pay equal to six months' severance and this within a timeframe of 45 days after the termination of the contract.

Article 18 - Change of control

1.
Any severance provided upon a “Change of Control” (as that term is defined in the WABCO Holdings Inc. Change of Control Severance Plan (the “Change of Control Plan”)) shall be provided pursuant to the terms of the Change of Control Plan. Any such payment shall be in lieu of any severance payment that might be payable under article 17 or otherwise


Article 19 - Notification

Any notification in connection with the Agreement must be made in writing and in English and shall be validly given with respect to each party if sent by registered mail or courier to the addresses set out in the beginning of this Management Agreement or to such other address as a party may notify to the other in accordance with this clause.

Article 20 - Section 409A

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the Agreement, in the event that the Business Manager is or becomes a U.S. citizen or resident alien during the term of the Agreement, the special payment provisions to comply with Section 409A of the Code that are set forth in annex 4 shall apply.


Article 21 - Enforceability

Any provision of the Agreement or part thereof which would be declared null and void, will be considered separated from the Agreement, which, for the remainder, will remain applicable.






Article 22 - Applicable law / Jurisdiction

1.
The Agreement is governed by Belgian law and any dispute concerning the interpretation, performance and/or termination of the Agreement must be resolved under Belgian law.

2.
The courts of Brussels have exclusive authority in relation to every dispute connected to the interpretation, the performance and/or the termination of the Agreement. By executing the Agreement, the Business Manager consents to the jurisdiction of the Belgian courts with respect to the Agreement.

Article 23 - Entire agreement

1.
The Agreement constitutes the entire agreement existing between parties, with respect to services performed hereunder during periods on and after the Effective Date. It replaces every other agreement and/or arrangement between parties to the extent that its provisions are incompatible with the provisions of the Agreement.

2.
All policies referred to in the Agreement, whether attached to this agreement as an annex or not, form an integral part of the Agreement and have the same legal value.

Established in two original copies in Brussels on December 19, 2011, both parties acknowledging receipt of one original copy duly signed by the other parties.


The Business Manager                              For the Company,
Nikhil Varty                                  Jacques Esculier
(“ read and approved ”)                              Business Manager




__________                                  __________
[ signature* ]                                  [ signature ]

Ulrich Michel
Business Manager




__________
[ signature ]





MANAGEMENT AGREEMENT



BETWEEN:

WABCO Europe SPRL/BVBA , having its registered offices at 1160 Brussels, Chaussée de Wavre/Waversesteenweg 1789, with company number 0475.956.135;

Hereinafter referred to as “the Company”;

Represented for the purposes of the Agreement by Mr. Jacques Esculier and Mr. Ulrich Michel in their capacity of Business Manager of the Company;


AND:

Mr. Kevin Tarrant , residing at
Hereinafter referred to as “the Business Manager”;


TAKING INTO ACCOUNT THE FOLLOWING;


WHEREAS the Company undertakes and warrants that the Business Manager will be appointed as a remunerated general manager of the Company by its General Assembly of Shareholders with effect as of January 1, 2012;

WHEREAS the Company and the Business Manager wish to determine in a written agreement (“the Agreement”) the terms and conditions under which the latter will perform the office as business manager of the Company effective as of January 1, 2012 (the “Effective Date”);


IT HAS BEEN AGREED AS FOLLOWS :

Article 1 - Object of the agreement

1.
The Business Manager agrees to perform the office of business manager of the Company. In his capacity of business manager, he will manage the Company subject to the terms and conditions of the Agreement.

2.
Pursuant to generally applicable management practice, the Business Manager will attend all meetings of the Board of Business Managers and through his contribution and effort as business manager provide together with the other business managers the best possible management for the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will at all times respect and abide the division of decision and representation powers for business managers as established by the Shareholder's meeting in the articles of association as well as any other Company policy which may affect him as a business manager of the Company.

1.
The Board of Business Managers may delegate special powers to the Business Manager within the framework of his office as business manager, and the Business Manager will carry them out to the best of his abilities.


Article 2 - The conditions of the agreement

1.
The Business Manager shall perform the Agreement on a self-employed basis.

2.
The Business Manager will be available for the performance of the Agreement during the time considered necessary





in order to fulfill his obligations resulting from this agreement. To that effect, the Business Manager accepts to be available during regular office hours and to perform 225 man-days per calendar year.

Prior to the beginning of the Agreement and during the performance thereof, the Business Manager will inform the Company in writing of any other positions (whether remunerated or not) which he holds in any other company or association. The Company has the right to request the Business Manager terminate such positions to the extent that they could possibly hinder the proper performance of the Agreement.

In addition, the Business Manager will refrain from accepting any position (whether remunerated or not) in any other company or association which might conflict with the proper performance of the Agreement, except with the prior written consent of the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will be provided with the necessary infrastructure, logistical support and documentation of the Company insofar as it is necessary for the proper performance of the Agreement.

4.
As holder of a corporate mandate, the Business Manager agrees to respect all instructions in relation to safety and health, which are applicable within the premises of the Company where personnel are working. The Business Manager explicitly allows the Company to take the necessary measures in his name in the event any problem would arise in this respect.

5.
The Business Manager shall report to the Chairman of the Board of Business Managers on the progress of his activities at the moments determined by the Board of Business Managers of the Company, its Chairman or whenever the parties to the Agreement consider it to be necessary.

6.
The Business Manager shall perform his office as business manager of the Company as a normal prudent business manager, with due diligence and in accordance with generally accepted and consistently applied business practices. The Business Manager shall, at all times, (a) take into consideration the objectives and best interest of the Company and the WABCO group in general, (b) comply with all applicable laws and regulations and (c) comply with all corporate policies and codes of business ethics established by the Company or the WABCO group in general, including but not necessarily limited to global policies relating to technology, operations, human resources, finance, and proposal and contract approvals.

7.
The Business manager will be covered by the WABCO Director and Officers Policy, covering the liability of company directors and officers.


Article 3 - Place of performance and mobility

1.
The Business Manager agrees to fulfill his duties and responsibilities under this Agreement from the business premises of the Company in Belgium.

2.
In view of the international scope of activities and business of the Company, the Business Manager acknowledges and accepts that proper performance of the mandate may require that he travel to other locations abroad and performs temporary assignments abroad at any time.


Article 4 - Base salary

1.
For the duration of the Agreement, the Company will pay the Business Manager a fixed annual remuneration of 267,800 EUR gross (hereinafter referred to as “the Base Salary”). The Base Salary shall be paid in 12 equal monthly installments per month performed, after deduction of the tax and any other contractual withholdings. In case of an incomplete year, the Base Salary shall be paid pro rata temporis.

2.
The Base Salary will be reviewed once a year, it being understood that such adjustment must be endorsed by the competent corporate body of the Company. The adjustment of the Base Salary will take effect as of the month of





July.


Article 5 - Incentives

1.
The Business Manager is eligible to participate in the Annual Incentive Plan (AIP) of the Company in accordance with rules and conditions of such plan which is subject to change from time to time. The Business Manager's individual AIP target (“the AIP Target”) amounts to 60 % of the Base Salary. The actual AIP payment (“the Actual AIP”) is based on the achievement of individual and company performance goals which are determined every performance year by the Compensation Nominating and Governance (CNG) committee of the Board of directors.

2.
The Business Manager is eligible to participate in the Cash Long Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) of the Company in accordance with rules and conditions of such plan which is subject to change from time to time. The target LTIP (“the LTIP Target”) amounts to 45% of the average Base Salary over the three year cycle period. The actual LTIP payment (“the Actual LTIP”) is based on the achievement of company performance goals which are determined for each cycle by the CNG committee of the Board of directors.

3.
The Business Manager will be eligible for an annual equity grant based on the CNG committee's annual recommendation and in accordance with the provisions of the WABCO Omnibus Incentive Plan which is subject to change from time to time. The grant may consist of stock options and/or restricted stock awards or units or any other equity benefits.

Article 6 - Company car

1.
The Company shall provide the Business Manager with the use of a car and fuel card, pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Company's car policy which is subject to change from time to time. All costs associated with the use of the car shall be borne by the Company.

2.
The Business Manager can also make use of the company car for private purposes. The private use of the company car will be taxed as a benefit in kind in accordance with the official guidelines of the tax authorities. The Business Manager accepts that the taxation of the private use can change due to a modification of the legal rules of such a benefit.


Article 7 - Other benefits

The Company shall provide the Business Manager with the following benefits:
the use of a mobile phone, pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Company's mobile phone policy which is subject to change from time to time;
the use of a laptop.


Article 8 - Insurances

1.
The Business Manager will be covered by the company group insurance plan for its business managers, which is subject to change from time to time. The insurance plan covers extra-legal pension, death in service, invalidity and guaranteed income.

The Business Manager explicitly agrees that all personal contributions of the Business Manager will be deducted from his monthly salary.

A summary of the company group insurance plan is attached as Annex 1 to the Agreement.









2 .
Medical care will be covered through the Belgian social security scheme and a private medical insurance paid concluded by the Company for its business managers.

Article 9 - Expenses

1.
The Company will reimburse the Business Manager all professional costs he may incur in the normal execution of the Agreement provided they are reasonable and justified through expense reports.

Article 10 - Goods and services differential

1.
According to the Company's international mobility policy and when applicable, the Company used to compensate expatriates for cost of living differences between residing in the United States and Brussels, Belgium through the payment of a goods and services differential. Any such adjustment was based on average expenditures by income group and family size as established by an independent research service selected by the Company.

2.
Parties agree that the application of the goods and services differential will be fixed at the fourth quarter of 2011 differential i.e USD 39,932 or EUR 30,717 and will be phased-out during a three-year period starting as of January 2012 with the following percentages:

for the calendar year 2012: 100 % of the differential will be awarded;
for the calendar year 2013: 67 % of the differential will be awarded;
for the calendar year 2014: 33 % of the differential will be awarded;
as of calendar year 2015: no differential anymore.

Article 11 - Housing &Home Leave

1.
The Company will pay to the Business Manager a net monthly housing allowance of EUR 4,000 to be indexed on an annual basis based on rent indexes in Belgium. The Company will also reimburse for house utilities, including gas, water, electricity and maintenance.

2.
Home leave will be provided annually for the Business Manager and his family. Only transportation to and from home is provided.

Article 12 - Taxes

1.
The Company will notify the Belgian tax authorities on behalf of the Business Manager about the change of the status of the Business Manager in order to obtain a continuation of the special tax status for expatriates.

1.
The Business Manager will not undertake any action that could jeopardize the continued application of the special tax status for expatriates or reduce the benefits for the Company.

3.
The Business Manager shall provide to the Company or the Company's designated tax advisors all documents related to his professional travel outside Belgium, such as boarding passes, train tickets, visa stubs, etc.

4.
The Company will provide the Business Manager with tax assistance with regard to his Belgian income tax return at the Company's expense.

5.
As the Business Manager has the fiscal status of manager ('bedrijfsleider'/'dirigeant d'entreprise') for Belgian income tax purposes, the Company will deduct withholding taxes from the Business Manager's remuneration.

6.
The Business Manager understands and acknowledges that as of the start of the business manager status, he will be responsible for paying actual income taxes in Belgium. According to the company tax policy for business managers, the Company will however bear the actual income taxes in the United States, if any, under the applicable





tax equalization policy for business managers as attached as annex 2 to the agreement.


Article 13 - School allowance

1.
The Company will reimburse the Business Manager for the education costs of his dependent children in grades K to 12 (or up to the end of secondary school). Reimbursement under this provision shall be limited to tuition fees, books and necessary supplies, and local school transportation.


Article 14 - Social security

1.
The Business Manager will be subject to the Belgian social security scheme for self-employed workers, in accordance with the Belgian social security legislation.

The Business Manager will be solely liable for his personal social security obligations in relation to the performance of the Agreement. The Business Manager will register with a Belgian social insurance fund for self-employed workers. The Company will pay on behalf of the Business Manager the required quarterly social security contributions to the social insurance fund in order to keep their affiliation with the Belgian social security scheme for self-employed workers.

The Business Manager explicitly agrees that all payments made by the Company on behalf of the Business Manager will be deducted from his monthly salary.

Article 15 - Confidentiality

1.
All information, data, written materials, discs, files, software and/or any other document and/or material prepared for the benefit of or received by the Business Manager in execution of or during the performance of the Agreement and connected to the business of the Company, its clients and/or its personnel is qualified as confidential information (hereinafter referred to as “Confidential Information”) and will remain exclusively the property of the Company.

2.
At the moment of the effective termination of the Agreement, for whatever reason, or at the sole request of the Company during the performance of the Agreement, the Business Manager will immediately transfer all Confidential Information to the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will not be entitled to take or keep any transcript or copy of the Confidential Information, under whatever form, after the termination of the Agreement. All possible titles and/or intellectual rights that may be connected directly or indirectly with the Confidential Information belong to the Company and remain the sole property of the latter.

4.
Furthermore, the Business Manager will not reveal any Confidential Information to third parties and/or use this information on his own behalf or jointly with or on behalf of any person, firm or company after the termination of the Agreement for whatever reason.

5.
The present section does not apply with regard to information pertaining to the public domain.


Article 16 - Intellectual property

1.
All systems, programs, software (object codes as well as source codes), documents, databases, manuals, reports, trade secrets, inventions, improvements, know-how and all other work created, designed, developed or produced





by the Business Manager, whether or not by using the facilities of the Company, in the course of or in relation with the performance of this Management Agreement, or that relate to the activities of the Company (the “Works”) shall remain or become the exclusive property of the Company. This exclusivity implies but is not limited to the transfer and assignment of all intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works to the Company.

2.
All intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works (including but not limited to copyrights, trademark rights, rights on databases, rights on computer programs as well as patent rights) that have come into existence or will come into existence in the course of or in relation with the performance of the Agreement are immediately transferred and assigned to the Company as from their coming into existence or, as from the execution of this Management Agreement for rights already in existence at the time of contracting.

3.
The transfer and assignment of these intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works includes, but is not limited to the transfer and assignment of the right to reproduce, modify, translate, adapt, use to make derivative works, distribute, rent, lend and/or communicate the Works to the public, partially or completely, in each and any way, for internal (including but not limited to research and development) and external use. The transfer and assignment is valid for all countries, in the most extensive way possible as permitted by law, without limitation in time other than the legal duration of validity of these rights and without further payment than the fee as provided for executing the Agreement.

4.
The Business Manager undertakes to fully inform the Company, upon first demand of the Company, that it has created, designed, developed or produced certain Works. The Business Manager undertakes to fully communicate all information and know-how in relation to the Works to the Company, and this immediately upon the creation, design, development or production of the Works.

5.
Should the Company decide, without having any obligations whatsoever, to file for any registered intellectual property rights in relation to a Work, the Business Manager undertakes, upon first demand of the Company, upon expenses borne by the Company, to provide all necessary or useful cooperation and to provide and sign all documents in order to permit, facilitate or accelerate any application for any registered intellectual property right. The Business Manager undertakes not to apply for any registered intellectual property right or to ask a third party to apply for a registered intellectual property right related to the Works without the written express authorisation of the Company.

6.
The Company has the exclusive right to decide, when and how, to exploit the Works. Works that have not been exploited remain the exclusive property of the Company. The Company can adapt and modify the Works as it deems appropriate in order to exploit the Works. The Business Manager agrees not to oppose the adaptation or the modification of the Works. The Business Manager agrees that the Company may exploit the Works without mentioning the Business Manager's name.
     
Article 17 - Duration / Termination

1.
The Agreement shall enter into force on January 1, 2012, i.e. date of the Business Manager's appointment as business manager of the Company by the General Assembly of Shareholders of the Company.
2.
The Agreement is concluded for an indefinite duration .
3.
Except as provided in Article 18 , upon termination of the Business Manager's mandate by the General Assembly of Shareholders of the Company without Cause or by the Business manager for Good Reason (as these terms are defined in annex 3 to this Agreement), hence upon termination of the Agreement, the Company must pay the Business Manager a severance payment equal to 1.5 times the remuneration (as defined in paragraph 4 of this article 17).
However, if the Business Manager, in whatever function or capacity, accepts employment by or a collaboration agreement (including, for avoidance of doubt, a Business Management Agreement) with a company of the WABCO Group, this will not be considered as a termination of the Agreement by the Company in the framework of this article.





4.
Remuneration in the framework of the present article consists of the following elements:
a)
The Base Salary defined in article 4 of the Agreement;
b)
The AIP Target as defined in article 5.1. of the Agreement;
c)
Contributions for Group insurance and medical cover as defined in Article 8 of the Agreement
5.
Severance will however not be due if the Company terminates the Business Manager's mandate and hence the Agreement because of “Cause”.
6.
The Business manager will also be reimbursed for financial planning services of up to $5,000 for one year after the date of termination.
7.
The Business Manager will respect a reasonable notice period in case of resignation from his mandate. The reasonable notice period is three months in all cases, unless Parties agree otherwise. In case of resignation from his mandate by the Business Manager, the latter will not be entitled to the severance payment foreseen in article 17 .3.
8.
The Business Manager will not be entitled to any severance under this Management Agreement unless:
A) he executes a release of claims against the Company and its affiliated companies in a form acceptable to the Company; OR
B) a final irrevocable court decision intervened on all existing claims (apart from the entitlement to the remainder of the contractual severance) and the Business Manager executed a release of claims against the Company and its affiliated companies in a form acceptable to the Company for all other claims that may exist at that time.
In this respect the company agrees to pay an advance to the severance pay equal to six months' severance and this within a timeframe of 45 days after the termination of the contract.

Article 18 - Change of control

1.
Any severance provided upon a “Change of Control” (as that term is defined in the WABCO Holdings Inc. Change of Control Severance Plan (the “Change of Control Plan”)) shall be provided pursuant to the terms of the Change of Control Plan. Any such payment shall be in lieu of any severance payment that might be payable under article 17 or otherwise


Article 19 - Notification

Any notification in connection with the Agreement must be made in writing and in English and shall be validly given with respect to each party if sent by registered mail or courier to the addresses set out in the beginning of this Management Agreement or to such other address as a party may notify to the other in accordance with this clause.

Article 20 - Section 409A

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the Agreement, in the event that the Business Manager is or becomes a U.S. citizen or resident alien during the term of the Agreement, the special payment provisions to comply with Section 409A of the Code that are set forth in annex 4 shall apply.


Article 21 - Enforceability

Any provision of the Agreement or part thereof which would be declared null and void, will be considered separated from the Agreement, which, for the remainder, will remain applicable.






Article 22 - Applicable law / Jurisdiction

1.
The Agreement is governed by Belgian law and any dispute concerning the interpretation, performance and/or termination of the Agreement must be resolved under Belgian law.

2.
The courts of Brussels have exclusive authority in relation to every dispute connected to the interpretation, the performance and/or the termination of the Agreement. By executing the Agreement, the Business Manager consents to the jurisdiction of the Belgian courts with respect to the Agreement.

Article 23 - Entire agreement

1.
The Agreement constitutes the entire agreement existing between parties, with respect to services performed hereunder during periods on and after the Effective Date. It replaces every other agreement and/or arrangement between parties to the extent that its provisions are incompatible with the provisions of the Agreement.

2.
All policies referred to in the Agreement, whether attached to this agreement as an annex or not, form an integral part of the Agreement and have the same legal value.

Established in two original copies in Brussels on December 19, 2011, both parties acknowledging receipt of one original copy duly signed by the other parties.


The Business Manager                                  For the Company,
Kevin Tarrant                                      Jacques Esculier
(“ read and approved ”)                                  Business Manager




__________                                      __________
[ signature* ]                                      [ signature ]

Ulrich Michel
Business Manager




__________
[ signature ]





MANAGEMENT AGREEMENT



BETWEEN:

WABCO Europe SPRL/BVBA , having its registered offices at 1160 Brussels, Chaussée de Wavre/Waversesteenweg 1789, with company number 0475.956.135;

Hereinafter referred to as “the Company”;

Represented for the purposes of the Agreement by Mr. Jacques Esculier and Mr. Jozef Van Osta in their capacity of Business Manager of the Company;


AND:

M . Ulrich Michel , residing at;

Hereinafter referred to as “the Business Manager”;


TAKING INTO ACCOUNT THE FOLLOWING;


WHEREAS the Company undertakes and warrants that the Business Manager will be appointed as a remunerated general manager of the Company by its General Assembly of Shareholders with effect as of January 1, 2012;

WHEREAS the Company and the Business Manager wish to determine in a written agreement (“the Agreement”) the terms and conditions under which the latter will perform the office as business manager of the Company effective as of January 1, 2012 (the “Effective Date”);


IT HAS BEEN AGREED AS FOLLOWS :

Article 1 - Object of the agreement

1.
The Business Manager agrees to perform the office of business manager of the Company. In his capacity of business manager, he will manage the Company subject to the terms and conditions of the Agreement.

2.
Pursuant to generally applicable management practice, the Business Manager will attend all meetings of the Board of Business Managers and through his contribution and effort as business manager provide together with the other business managers the best possible management for the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will at all times respect and abide the division of decision and representation powers for business managers as established by the Shareholder's meeting in the articles of association as well as any other Company policy which may affect him as a business manager of the Company.

1.
The Board of Business Managers may delegate special powers to the Business Manager within the framework of his office as business manager, and the Business Manager will carry them out to the best of his abilities.


Article 2 - The conditions of the agreement

1.
The Business Manager shall perform the Agreement on a self-employed basis.






2.
The Business Manager will be available for the performance of the Agreement during the time considered necessary in order to fulfill his obligations resulting from this agreement. To that effect, the Business Manager accepts to be available during regular office hours and to perform 225 man-days per calendar year.

Prior to the beginning of the Agreement and during the performance thereof, the Business Manager will inform the Company in writing of any other positions (whether remunerated or not) which he holds in any other company or association. The Company has the right to request the Business Manager terminate such positions to the extent that they could possibly hinder the proper performance of the Agreement.

In addition, the Business Manager will refrain from accepting any position (whether remunerated or not) in any other company or association which might conflict with the proper performance of the Agreement, except with the prior written consent of the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will be provided with the necessary infrastructure, logistical support and documentation of the Company insofar as it is necessary for the proper performance of the Agreement.

4.
As holder of a corporate mandate, the Business Manager agrees to respect all instructions in relation to safety and health, which are applicable within the premises of the Company where personnel are working. The Business Manager explicitly allows the Company to take the necessary measures in his name in the event any problem would arise in this respect.

5.
The Business Manager shall report to the Chairman of the Board of Business Managers on the progress of his activities at the moments determined by the Board of Business Managers of the Company, its Chairman or whenever the parties to the Agreement consider it to be necessary.

6.
The Business Manager shall perform his office as business manager of the Company as a normal prudent business manager, with due diligence and in accordance with generally accepted and consistently applied business practices. The Business Manager shall, at all times, (a) take into consideration the objectives and best interest of the Company and the WABCO group in general, (b) comply with all applicable laws and regulations and (c) comply with all corporate policies and codes of business ethics established by the Company or the WABCO group in general, including but not necessarily limited to global policies relating to technology, operations, human resources, finance, and proposal and contract approvals.

7.
The Business manager will be covered by the WABCO Director and Officers Policy, covering the liability of company directors and officers.


Article 3 - Place of performance and mobility

1.
The Business Manager agrees to fulfill his duties and responsibilities under this Agreement from the business premises of the Company in Belgium.

2.
In view of the international scope of activities and business of the Company, the Business Manager acknowledges and accepts that proper performance of the mandate may require that he travels to other locations abroad and performs temporary assignments abroad at any time.


Article 4 - Base salary

1.
For the duration of the Agreement, the Company will pay the Business Manager a fixed annual remuneration of EUR 351,203 gross (hereinafter referred to as “the Base Salary”). The Base Salary shall be paid in 12 equal monthly installments per month performed, after deduction of the tax and any other contractual withholdings. In case of an incomplete year, the Base Salary shall be paid pro rata temporis.

2.
The Base Salary will be reviewed once a year, it being understood that such adjustment must be endorsed by the





competent corporate body of the Company. The adjustment of the Base Salary will take effect as of the month of July.


Article 5 - Incentives

1.
The Business Manager is eligible to participate in the Annual Incentive Plan (AIP) of the Company in accordance with rules and conditions of such plan which is subject to change from time to time. The Business Manager's individual AIP target (“the AIP Target”) amounts to 60% of the Base Salary. The actual AIP payment (“the Actual AIP”) is based on the achievement of individual and company performance goals which are determined every performance year by the Compensation Nominating and Governance committee (“the CNG Committee”)of WABCO's Board of directors. The Business Manager understands and agrees that the Actual AIP, if any, is composed of a cash payment (“Actual Cash AIP Payment”) and a mandatory deferral into the Company Supplemental Pension Plan referred to in article 8.2. of the Agreement, each element being of equal value.

2.
The Business Manager is eligible to participate in the Cash Long Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) of the Company in accordance with rules and conditions of such plan which is subject to change from time to time. The target LTIP (“the LTIP Target”) amounts to 45% of the average Base Salary over the three year cycle period. The actual LTIP payment (“the Actual LTIP”) is based on the achievement of company performance goals which are determined for each cycle by the CNG Committee.

 
3.
The Business Manager will be eligible for an annual equity grant based on the CNG Committee's annual recommendation and in accordance with the provisions of the WABCO Omnibus Incentive Plan which is subject to change from time to time. The grant may consist of stock options and/or restricted stock awards or units or any other equity benefits.

Article 6 - Company car

1.
The Company shall provide the Business Manager with the use of a car and fuel card, pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Company's car policy which is subject to change from time to time. All costs associated with the use of the car shall be borne by the Company.

2.
The Business Manager can also make use of the company car for private purposes. The private use of the company car will be taxed as a benefit in kind in accordance with the official guidelines of the tax authorities. The Business Manager accepts that the taxation of the private use can change due to a modification of the legal rules of such a benefit.


Article 7 - Other benefits

The Company shall provide the Business Manager with the following benefits:
the use of a mobile phone, pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Company's mobile phone policy which is subject to change from time to time;
the use of a laptop.


Article 8 - Insurances

1.
The Business Manager will be covered by the company group insurance plan for its business managers, which is subject to change from time to time. The insurance plan covers extra-legal pension, death in service, invalidity and guaranteed income.

The Business Manager explicitly agrees that all personal contributions of the Business Manager will be deducted from his monthly salary.






A summary of the company group insurance plan is attached as Annex 1 to the Agreement.

2.
The Business Manager will also take part in the Company Supplemental Pension Plan set up for the college of business managers. The related annual contributions to this supplemental plan are determined in article 5.1.


3 .
Medical care will be covered through the Belgian social security scheme and a private medical insurance paid concluded by the Company for its business managers and their dependent family members.

4.
If the Business Manager is unable to perform his duties and obligation through illness or inability to work, the Business Manager will be entitled to receive his Base Salary during the first month of illness or inability to work. After the initial period of 30 or 31 consecutive days the company group insurance plan defined in article 8 of the present agreement applies. This will be subject to the production of medical certificates and to such other requirement as the Company, as well as the insurance company may reasonably impose.


Article 9 - Expenses

1.
The Company will reimburse the Business Manager all professional costs (except those covered under article 9.1 above)he may incur in the normal execution of the Agreement provided they are reasonable and justified through expense reports.

Article 10 - Housing

1.
The Company will pay to the Business Manager a monthly gross housing allowance of EUR 6,390 to be indexed on an annual basis based on rent indexes in Belgium. The Company will also reimburse for house utilities, including gas, water, electricity and maintenance.


Article 11 - Taxes

1.
The Company will notify the Belgian tax authorities on behalf of the Business Manager about the change of the status of the Business Manager in order to obtain a continuation of the special tax status for expatriates.

2.
The Business Manager will not undertake any action that could jeopardize the continued application of the special tax status for expatriates or reduce the benefits for the Company.

3.
The Business Manager shall provide to the Company or the Company's designated tax advisors all documents related to his professional travel outside Belgium, such as boarding passes, train tickets, visa stubs, etc.

4.
The Company will provide the Business Manager with tax assistance with regard to his Belgian income tax return at the Company's expense.

5.
As the Business Manager has the fiscal status of manager ('bedrijfsleider'/'dirigeant d'entreprise') for Belgian income tax purposes, the Company will deduct withholding taxes from the Business Manager's remuneration.

6.
Stock options that have been granted in the past when the Business Manager was subject to tax equalization (whereby a hypothetical tax was calculated and deducted on the professional income taking into account the tax rules of the home country being the US), will be treated as follows:

Upon exercise, an amount will be withheld from the exercise gain, being the lesser of:

the Belgian income tax paid upon grant (including any tax payable at another moment within the rules of the specific Belgian legislation of March 26, 1999 on stock options) OR the Belgian income tax payable at exercise





(if no taxation should have taken place at grant); AND
the hypothetical tax that would have been due under the conditions of the previous tax equalization agreement.


Article 12 - School allowance

1.
The Company will reimburse the Business Manager for the education costs of his dependent children in grades K to 12 (or up to the end of secondary school). Reimbursement under this provision shall be limited to tuition fees, books and necessary supplies, and local school transportation.



Article 13 - Social security

1.
The Business Manager will be subject to the Belgian social security scheme for self-employed workers, in accordance with the Belgian social security legislation.

The Business Manager will be solely liable for his personal social security obligations in relation to the performance of the Agreement. The Business Manager will register with a Belgian social insurance fund for self-employed workers. The Company will pay on behalf of the Business Manager the required quarterly social security contributions to the social insurance fund in order to keep their affiliation with the Belgian social security scheme for self-employed workers.

The Business Manager explicitly agrees that all payments made by the Company on behalf of the Business Manager will be deducted from his monthly salary.


Article 14 - Confidentiality

1.
All information, data, written materials, discs, files, software and/or any other document and/or material prepared for the benefit of or received by the Business Manager in execution of or during the performance of the Agreement and connected to the business of the Company, its clients and/or its personnel is qualified as confidential information (hereinafter referred to as “Confidential Information”) and will remain exclusively the property of the Company.

2.
At the moment of the effective termination of the Agreement, for whatever reason, or at the sole request of the Company during the performance of the Agreement, the Business Manager will immediately transfer all Confidential Information to the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will not be entitled to take or keep any transcript or copy of the Confidential Information, under whatever form, after the termination of the Agreement. All possible titles and/or intellectual rights that may be connected directly or indirectly with the Confidential Information belong to the Company and remain the sole property of the latter.

4.
Furthermore, the Business Manager will not reveal any Confidential Information to third parties and/or use this information on his own behalf or jointly with or on behalf of any person, firm or company after the termination of the Agreement for whatever reason.

5.
The present section does not apply with regard to information pertaining to the public domain.


Article 15 - Intellectual property






1.
All systems, programs, software (object codes as well as source codes), documents, databases, manuals, reports, trade secrets, inventions, improvements, know-how and all other work created, designed, developed or produced by the Business Manager, whether or not by using the facilities of the Company, in the course of or in relation with the performance of this Management Agreement, or that relate to the activities of the Company (the “Works”) shall remain or become the exclusive property of the Company. This exclusivity implies but is not limited to the transfer and assignment of all intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works to the Company.

2.
All intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works (including but not limited to copyrights, trademark rights, rights on databases, rights on computer programs as well as patent rights) that have come into existence or will come into existence in the course of or in relation with the performance of the Agreement are immediately transferred and assigned to the Company as from their coming into existence or, as from the execution of this Management Agreement for rights already in existence at the time of contracting.

3.
The transfer and assignment of these intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works includes, but is not limited to the transfer and assignment of the right to reproduce, modify, translate, adapt, use to make derivative works, distribute, rent, lend and/or communicate the Works to the public, partially or completely, in each and any way, for internal (including but not limited to research and development) and external use. The transfer and assignment is valid for all countries, in the most extensive way possible as permitted by law, without limitation in time other than the legal duration of validity of these rights and without further payment than the fee as provided for executing the Agreement.

4.
The Business Manager undertakes to fully inform the Company, upon first demand of the Company, that it has created, designed, developed or produced certain Works. The Business Manager undertakes to fully communicate all information and know-how in relation to the Works to the Company, and this immediately upon the creation, design, development or production of the Works.

5.
Should the Company decide, without having any obligations whatsoever, to file for any registered intellectual property rights in relation to a Work, the Business Manager undertakes, upon first demand of the Company, upon expenses borne by the Company, to provide all necessary or useful cooperation and to provide and sign all documents in order to permit, facilitate or accelerate any application for any registered intellectual property right. The Business Manager undertakes not to apply for any registered intellectual property right or to ask a third party to apply for a registered intellectual property right related to the Works without the written express authorisation of the Company.

6.
The Company has the exclusive right to decide, when and how, to exploit the Works. Works that have not been exploited remain the exclusive property of the Company. The Company can adapt and modify the Works as it deems appropriate in order to exploit the Works. The Business Manager agrees not to oppose the adaptation or the modification of the Works. The Business Manager agrees that the Company may exploit the Works without mentioning the Business Manager's name.
     
Article 16 - Duration / Termination

1.
The Agreement shall enter into force on January 1, 2012, i.e. date of the Business Manager's appointment as business manager of the Company by the General Assembly of Shareholders of the Company.
2.
The Agreement is concluded for an indefinite duration .
3.
Except as provided in Article 17 , upon termination of the Business Manager's mandate by the General Assembly of Shareholders of the Company without Cause or by the Business manager for Good Reason (as these terms are defined in annex 2 to this Agreement), hence upon termination of the Agreement, the Company must pay the Business Manager a severance payment equal to 1.5 times the remuneration (as defined in paragraph 4 of this article 16).
However, if the Business Manager, in whatever function or capacity, accepts employment by or a collaboration





agreement (including, for avoidance of doubt, a Business Management Agreement) with a company of the WABCO Group, this will not be considered as a termination of the Agreement by the Company in the framework of this article.
4.
Remuneration in the framework of the present article consists of the following elements:
a)
The Base Salary defined in article 4 of the Agreement;
b)
The AIP Target as defined in article 5.1. of the Agreement;
c)
Contributions for Group insurance and medical cover as defined in Article 8 of the Agreement
5.
Severance will however not be due if the Company terminates the Business Manager's mandate and hence the Agreement because of “Cause”.
6.
The Business manager will also be reimbursed for financial planning services of up to $5,000 for one year after the date of termination.
7.
The Business Manager will respect a reasonable notice period in case of resignation from his mandate. The reasonable notice period is three months in all cases, unless Parties agree otherwise. In case of resignation from his mandate by the Business Manager, the latter will not be entitled to the severance payment foreseen in article 16 .3.
8.
The Business Manager will not be entitled to any severance under this Management Agreement unless:
A) he executes a release of claims against the Company and its affiliated companies in a form acceptable to the Company; OR
B) a final irrevocable court decision intervened on all existing claims (apart from the entitlement to the remainder of the contractual severance) and the Business Manager executed a release of claims against the Company and its affiliated companies in a form acceptable to the Company for all other claims that may exist at that time.
In this respect the company agrees to pay an advance to the severance pay equal to six months' severance and this within a timeframe of 45 days after the termination of the contract.

Article 17 - Change of control

1.
Any severance provided upon a “Change of Control” (as that term is defined in the WABCO Holdings Inc. Change of Control Severance Plan (the “Change of Control Plan”)) shall be provided pursuant to the terms of the Change of Control Plan. Any such payment shall be in lieu of any severance payment that might be payable under article 16 or otherwise

Article 18 - Notification

Any notification in connection with the Agreement must be made in writing and in English and shall be validly given with respect to each party if sent by registered mail or courier to the addresses set out in the beginning of this Management Agreement or to such other address as a party may notify to the other in accordance with this clause.

Article 19 - Enforceability

Any provision of the Agreement or part thereof which would be declared null and void, will be considered separated from the Agreement, which, for the remainder, will remain applicable.


Article 20 - Applicable law / Jurisdiction

1.
The Agreement is governed by Belgian law and any dispute concerning the interpretation, performance and/or termination of the Agreement must be resolved under Belgian law.






2.
The courts of Brussels have exclusive authority in relation to every dispute connected to the interpretation, the performance and/or the termination of the Agreement. By executing the Agreement, the Business Manager consents to the jurisdiction of the Belgian courts with respect to the Agreement.


Article 21 - Entire agreement

1.
The Agreement constitutes the entire agreement existing between parties, with respect to services performed hereunder during periods on and after the Effective Date. It replaces every other agreement and/or arrangement between parties to the extent that its provisions are incompatible with the provisions of the Agreement.

2.
All policies referred to in the Agreement, whether attached to this agreement as an annex or not, form an integral part of the Agreement and have the same legal value.

Established in two original copies in Brussels on December 19, 2011, both parties acknowledging receipt of one original copy duly signed by the other parties.

The Business Manager                              For the Company,
Ulrich Michel                                  Jacques Esculier
(“ read and approved ”)                              Business Manager





__________                                  __________
[ signature* ]                                  [ signature ]

Jozef Van Osta
Business Manager





__________
[ signature ]


    






MANAGEMENT AGREEMENT



BETWEEN:

WABCO Europe SPRL/BVBA , having its registered offices at 1160 Brussels, Chaussée de Wavre/Waversesteenweg 1789, with company number 0475.956.135;

Hereinafter referred to as “the Company”;

Represented for the purposes of the Agreement by Mr. Jacques Esculier and Mr. Ulrich Michel in their capacity of Business Manager of the Company;


AND:

Mr . Jean-Christophe Figueroa , residing at;

Hereinafter referred to as “the Business Manager”;


TAKING INTO ACCOUNT THE FOLLOWING;


WHEREAS the Company undertakes and warrants that the Business Manager will be appointed as a remunerated general manager of the Company by its General Assembly of Shareholders with effect as of January 1, 2012;

WHEREAS the Company and the Business Manager wish to determine in a written agreement (“the Agreement”) the terms and conditions under which the latter will perform the office as business manager of the Company effective as of January 1, 2012 (the “Effective Date”);


IT HAS BEEN AGREED AS FOLLOWS :

Article 1 - Object of the agreement

1.
The Business Manager agrees to perform the office of business manager of the Company. In his capacity of business manager, he will manage the Company subject to the terms and conditions of the Agreement.

2.
Pursuant to generally applicable management practice, the Business Manager will attend all meetings of the Board of Business Managers and through his contribution and effort as business manager provide together with the other business managers the best possible management for the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will at all times respect and abide the division of decision and representation powers for business managers as established by the Shareholder's meeting in the articles of association as well as any other Company policy which may affect him as a business manager of the Company.

1.
The Board of Business Managers may delegate special powers to the Business Manager within the framework of his office as business manager, and the Business Manager will carry them out to the best of his abilities.


Article 2 - The conditions of the agreement

1.
The Business Manager shall perform the Agreement on a self-employed basis.






2.
The Business Manager will be available for the performance of the Agreement during the time considered necessary in order to fulfill his obligations resulting from this agreement. To that effect, the Business Manager accepts to be available during regular office hours and to perform 225 man-days per calendar year.

Prior to the beginning of the Agreement and during the performance thereof, the Business Manager will inform the Company in writing of any other positions (whether remunerated or not) which he holds in any other company or association. The Company has the right to request the Business Manager terminate such positions to the extent that they could possibly hinder the proper performance of the Agreement.

In addition, the Business Manager will refrain from accepting any position (whether remunerated or not) in any other company or association which might conflict with the proper performance of the Agreement, except with the prior written consent of the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will be provided with the necessary infrastructure, logistical support and documentation of the Company insofar as it is necessary for the proper performance of the Agreement.

4.
As holder of a corporate mandate, the Business Manager agrees to respect all instructions in relation to safety and health, which are applicable within the premises of the Company where personnel are working. The Business Manager explicitly allows the Company to take the necessary measures in his name in the event any problem would arise in this respect.

5.
The Business Manager shall report to the Chairman of the Board of Business Managers on the progress of his activities at the moments determined by the Board of Business Managers of the Company, its Chairman or whenever the parties to the Agreement consider it to be necessary.

6.
The Business Manager shall perform his office as business manager of the Company as a normal prudent business manager, with due diligence and in accordance with generally accepted and consistently applied business practices. The Business Manager shall, at all times, (a) take into consideration the objectives and best interest of the Company and the WABCO group in general, (b) comply with all applicable laws and regulations and (c) comply with all corporate policies and codes of business ethics established by the Company or the WABCO group in general, including but not necessarily limited to global policies relating to technology, operations, human resources, finance, and proposal and contract approvals.

7.
The Business manager will be covered by the WABCO Director and Officers Policy, covering the liability of company directors and officers.


Article 3 - Place of performance and mobility

1.
The Business Manager agrees to fulfill his duties and responsibilities under this Agreement from the business premises of the Company in Belgium.

2.
In view of the international scope of activities and business of the Company, the Business Manager acknowledges and accepts that proper performance of the mandate may require that he travels to other locations abroad and performs temporary assignments abroad at any time.


Article 4 - Base salary

1.
For the duration of the Agreement, the Company will pay the Business Manager a fixed annual remuneration of EUR 295,033 gross (hereinafter referred to as “the Base Salary”). The Base Salary shall be paid in 12 equal monthly installments per month performed, after deduction of the tax and any other contractual withholdings. In case of an incomplete year, the Base Salary shall be paid pro rata temporis.

2.
The Base Salary will be reviewed once a year, it being understood that such adjustment must be endorsed by the





competent corporate body of the Company. The adjustment of the Base Salary will take effect as of the month of July.


Article 5 - Incentives

1.
The Business Manager is eligible to participate in the Annual Incentive Plan (AIP) of the Company in accordance with rules and conditions of such plan which is subject to change from time to time. The Business Manager's individual AIP target (“the AIP Target”) amounts to 60% of the Base Salary. The actual AIP payment (“the Actual AIP”) is based on the achievement of individual and company performance goals which are determined every performance year by the Compensation Nominating and Governance committee (“the CNG Committee”) of WABCO's Board of directors. The Business Manager understands and agrees that the Actual AIP, if any, is composed of a cash payment (“Actual Cash AIP Payment”) and a mandatory deferral into the Company Supplemental Pension Plan referred to in article 8.2. of the Agreement, each element being of equal value.

2.
The Business Manager is eligible to participate in the Cash Long Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) of the Company in accordance with rules and conditions of such plan which is subject to change from time to time. The target LTIP (“the LTIP Target”) amounts to 45% of the average Base Salary over the three year cycle period. The actual LTIP payment (“the Actual LTIP”) is based on the achievement of company performance goals which are determined for each cycle by the CNG Committee.

 

3.
The Business Manager will be eligible for an annual equity grant based on the CNG committee's annual recommendation and in accordance with the provisions of the WABCO Omnibus Incentive Plan which is subject to change from time to time. The grant may consist of stock options and/or restricted stock awards or units or any other equity benefits.

Article 6 - Company car

1.
The Company shall provide the Business Manager with the use of a car and fuel card, pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Company's car policy which is subject to change from time to time. All costs associated with the use of the car shall be borne by the Company.

2.
The Business Manager can also make use of the company car for private purposes. The private use of the company car will be taxed as a benefit in kind in accordance with the official guidelines of the tax authorities. The Business Manager accepts that the taxation of the private use can change due to a modification of the legal rules of such a benefit.


Article 7 - Other benefits

The Company shall provide the Business Manager with the following benefits:
the use of a mobile phone, pursuant to the terms and conditions of the Company's mobile phone policy which is subject to change from time to time;
the use of a laptop.


Article 8 - Insurances

1.
The Business Manager will be covered by the company group insurance plan for its business managers, which is subject to change from time to time. The insurance plan covers extra-legal pension, death in service, invalidity and guaranteed income.

The Business Manager explicitly agrees that all personal contributions of the Business Manager will be deducted





from his monthly salary.

A summary of the company group insurance plan is attached as Annex 1 to the Agreement.

2.
The Business Manager will also take part in the Company Supplemental Pension Plan set up for the college of business managers. The related annual contributions to this supplemental plan are determined in article 5.1.


3 .
Medical care will be covered through the Belgian social security scheme and a private medical insurance paid concluded by the Company for its business managers and their dependent family members.

4.
If the Business Manager is unable to perform his duties and obligation through illness or inability to work, the Business Manager will be entitled to receive his Base Salary during the first month of illness or inability to work. After the initial period of 30 or 31 consecutive days the company group insurance plan defined in article 8 of the present agreement applies. This will be subject to the production of medical certificates and to such other requirement as the Company, as well as the insurance company may reasonably impose.

Article 9 - Expenses


2.
The Company will reimburse the Business Manager all professional costs he may incur in the normal execution of the Agreement provided they are reasonable and justified through expense reports.


Article 10 - Housing & Home Leave

1.
The Company will pay to the Business Manager a monthly net housing allowance of EUR 3,529 to be indexed on an annual basis based on rent indexes in Belgium. The Company will also reimburse for house utilities, including gas, water, electricity and maintenance.

2.
Home leave to Mexico will be provided annually for the Business Manager and his family. Only transportation to and from home is provided.

Article 11 - Taxes

1.
The Company will notify the Belgian tax authorities on behalf of the Business Manager about the change of the status of the Business Manager in order to obtain a continuation of the special tax status for expatriates.

1.
The Business Manager will not undertake any action that could jeopardize the continued application of the special tax status for expatriates or reduce the benefits for the Company.

2.
The Business Manager shall provide to the Company or the Company's designated tax advisors all documents related to his professional travel outside Belgium, such as boarding passes, train tickets, visa stubs, etc.

4.
The Company will provide the Business Manager with tax assistance with regard to his Belgian income tax return at the Company's expense.

5.
As the Business Manager has the fiscal status of manager ('bedrijfsleider'/'dirigeant d'entreprise') for Belgian income tax purposes, the Company will deduct withholding taxes from the Business Manager's remuneration.


Article 12 - School allowance

1.
The Company will reimburse the Business Manager for the education costs of his dependent children in grades





K to 12 (or up to the end of secondary school)Reimbursement under this provision shall be limited to tuition fees, books and necessary supplies, and local school transportation.


Article 13 - Social security

1.
The Business Manager will be subject to the Belgian social security scheme for self-employed workers, in accordance with the Belgian social security legislation.

The Business Manager will be solely liable for his personal social security obligations in relation to the performance of the Agreement. The Business Manager will register with a Belgian social insurance fund for self-employed workers. The Company will pay on behalf of the Business Manager the required quarterly social security contributions to the social insurance fund in order to keep their affiliation with the Belgian social security scheme for self-employed workers.

The Business Manager explicitly agrees that all payments made by the Company on behalf of the Business Manager will be deducted from his monthly salary.


Article 14 - Confidentiality

1.
All information, data, written materials, discs, files, software and/or any other document and/or material prepared for the benefit of or received by the Business Manager in execution of or during the performance of the Agreement and connected to the business of the Company, its clients and/or its personnel is qualified as confidential information (hereinafter referred to as “Confidential Information”) and will remain exclusively the property of the Company.

2.
At the moment of the effective termination of the Agreement, for whatever reason, or at the sole request of the Company during the performance of the Agreement, the Business Manager will immediately transfer all Confidential Information to the Company.

3.
The Business Manager will not be entitled to take or keep any transcript or copy of the Confidential Information, under whatever form, after the termination of the Agreement. All possible titles and/or intellectual rights that may be connected directly or indirectly with the Confidential Information belong to the Company and remain the sole property of the latter.

4.
Furthermore, the Business Manager will not reveal any Confidential Information to third parties and/or use this information on his own behalf or jointly with or on behalf of any person, firm or company after the termination of the Agreement for whatever reason.

5.
The present section does not apply with regard to information pertaining to the public domain.


Article 15 - Intellectual property

1.
All systems, programs, software (object codes as well as source codes), documents, databases, manuals, reports, trade secrets, inventions, improvements, know-how and all other work created, designed, developed or produced by the Business Manager, whether or not by using the facilities of the Company, in the course of or in relation with the performance of this Management Agreement, or that relate to the activities of the Company (the “Works”) shall remain or become the exclusive property of the Company. This exclusivity implies but is not limited to the transfer and assignment of all intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works to the Company.






2.
All intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works (including but not limited to copyrights, trademark rights, rights on databases, rights on computer programs as well as patent rights) that have come into existence or will come into existence in the course of or in relation with the performance of the Agreement are immediately transferred and assigned to the Company as from their coming into existence or, as from the execution of this Management Agreement for rights already in existence at the time of contracting.

3.
The transfer and assignment of these intellectual and other proprietary rights in the Works includes, but is not limited to the transfer and assignment of the right to reproduce, modify, translate, adapt, use to make derivative works, distribute, rent, lend and/or communicate the Works to the public, partially or completely, in each and any way, for internal (including but not limited to research and development) and external use. The transfer and assignment is valid for all countries, in the most extensive way possible as permitted by law, without limitation in time other than the legal duration of validity of these rights and without further payment than the fee as provided for executing the Agreement.

4.
The Business Manager undertakes to fully inform the Company, upon first demand of the Company, that it has created, designed, developed or produced certain Works. The Business Manager undertakes to fully communicate all information and know-how in relation to the Works to the Company, and this immediately upon the creation, design, development or production of the Works.

5.
Should the Company decide, without having any obligations whatsoever, to file for any registered intellectual property rights in relation to a Work, the Business Manager undertakes, upon first demand of the Company, upon expenses borne by the Company, to provide all necessary or useful cooperation and to provide and sign all documents in order to permit, facilitate or accelerate any application for any registered intellectual property right. The Business Manager undertakes not to apply for any registered intellectual property right or to ask a third party to apply for a registered intellectual property right related to the Works without the written express authorisation of the Company.

6.
The Company has the exclusive right to decide, when and how, to exploit the Works. Works that have not been exploited remain the exclusive property of the Company. The Company can adapt and modify the Works as it deems appropriate in order to exploit the Works. The Business Manager agrees not to oppose the adaptation or the modification of the Works. The Business Manager agrees that the Company may exploit the Works without mentioning the Business Manager's name.
     
Article 16 - Duration / Termination

1.
The Agreement shall enter into force on January 1, 2012, i.e. date of the Business Manager's appointment as business manager of the Company by the General Assembly of Shareholders of the Company.
2.
The Agreement is concluded for an indefinite duration .
3.
Except as provided in Article 17 , upon termination of the Business Manager's mandate by the General Assembly of Shareholders of the Company without Cause or by the Business manager for Good Reason (as these terms are defined in annex 2 to this Agreement), hence upon termination of the Agreement, the Company must pay the Business Manager a severance payment equal to 1.5 times the remuneration (as defined in paragraph 4 of this article 16).
However, if the Business Manager, in whatever function or capacity, accepts employment by or a collaboration agreement (including, for avoidance of doubt, a Business Management Agreement) with a company of the WABCO Group, this will not be considered as a termination of the Agreement by the Company in the framework of this article.
4.
Remuneration in the framework of the present article consists of the following elements:
a)
The Base Salary defined in article 4 of the Agreement;
b)
The AIP Target as defined in article 5.1. of the Agreement;
c)
Contributions for Group insurance and medical cover as defined in Article 8 of the Agreement





5.
Severance will however not be due if the Company terminates the Business Manager's mandate and hence the Agreement because of “Cause”.
6.
The Business manager will also be reimbursed for financial planning services of up to $5,000 for one year after the date of termination.
7.
The Business Manager will respect a reasonable notice period in case of resignation from his mandate. The reasonable notice period is three months in all cases, unless Parties agree otherwise. In case of resignation from his mandate by the Business Manager, the latter will not be entitled to the severance payment foreseen in article 16 .3.
8.
The Business Manager will not be entitled to any severance under this Management Agreement unless:
A) he executes a release of claims against the Company and its affiliated companies in a form acceptable to the Company; OR
B) a final irrevocable court decision intervened on all existing claims (apart from the entitlement to the remainder of the contractual severance) and the Business Manager executed a release of claims against the Company and its affiliated companies in a form acceptable to the Company for all other claims that may exist at that time.
In this respect the company agrees to pay an advance to the severance pay equal to six months' severance and this within a timeframe of 45 days after the termination of the contract.

Article 17 - Change of control

1.
Any severance provided upon a “Change of Control” (as that term is defined in the WABCO Holdings Inc. Change of Control Severance Plan (the “Change of Control Plan”)) shall be provided pursuant to the terms of the Change of Control Plan. Any such payment shall be in lieu of any severance payment that might be payable under article 16 or otherwise

Article 18 - Notification

Any notification in connection with the Agreement must be made in writing and in English and shall be validly given with respect to each party if sent by registered mail or courier to the addresses set out in the beginning of this Management Agreement or to such other address as a party may notify to the other in accordance with this clause.


Article 19 - Enforceability

Any provision of the Agreement or part thereof which would be declared null and void, will be considered separated from the Agreement, which, for the remainder, will remain applicable.


Article 20 - Applicable law / Jurisdiction

1.
The Agreement is governed by Belgian law and any dispute concerning the interpretation, performance and/or termination of the Agreement must be resolved under Belgian law.

2.
The courts of Brussels have exclusive authority in relation to every dispute connected to the interpretation, the performance and/or the termination of the Agreement. By executing the Agreement, the Business Manager consents to the jurisdiction of the Belgian courts with respect to the Agreement.


Article 21 - Entire agreement

1.
The Agreement constitutes the entire agreement existing between parties, with respect to services performed





hereunder during periods on and after the Effective Date. It replaces every other agreement and/or arrangement between parties to the extent that its provisions are incompatible with the provisions of the Agreement.

2.
All policies referred to in the Agreement, whether attached to this agreement as an annex or not, form an integral part of the Agreement and have the same legal value.

Established in two original copies in Brussels on December 19, 2011, both parties acknowledging receipt of one original copy duly signed by the other parties.

The Business Manager                              For the Company,
Jean-Christophe Figueroa                          Jacques Esculier
(“ read and approved ”)                              Business Manager




__________                                  __________
[ signature* ]                                  [ signature ]


Ulrich Michel
Business Manager





__________
[ signature ]


    






Exhibit 21.1
Subsidiaries and Affiliates of WABCO Holdings, Inc.

Name
  
Jurisdiction of Incorporation
WABCO Holdings B.V.
  
Netherlands
WABCO Europe Holdings LLC
  
Delaware
WABCO Europe BVBA
  
Belgium
WABCO LP
  
Bermuda
WABCO International LLC
  
Delaware
WABCO Financial Services BVBA
  
Belgium
WABCO Finance Ltd.
  
Bermuda
Clayton Dewandre Holdings Ltd.
  
United Kingdom
Meritor WABCO Vehicle Control Systems, a partnership
  
Delaware
Shangdong Weiming Automotive Products Ltd.
  
China, Peoples Republic of
WABCO Air Compressor Holdings Inc.
  
Delaware
WABCO Asia Private Ltd.
  
Singapore
WABCO Australia Pty Ltd.
  
Australia
WABCO Austria GesmbH
  
Austria
WABCO Automotive AB
  
Sweden
WABCO Automotive B.V.
  
Netherlands
WABCO Automotive Control Systems Inc.
  
Delaware
WABCO Automotive Italia S.r.L.
  
Italy
WABCO Automotive Pension Trustees Ltd.
  
United Kingdom
WABCO Automotive Products Ltd.
  
Cayman Islands
WABCO Automotive South Africa, a partnership
  
South Africa
WABCO Automotive UK Limited
  
United Kingdom
WABCO Belgium BVBA
  
Belgium
WABCO do Brasil Industria e Comercio de Freios Ltda
  
Brazil
WABCO brzdy k vozidlum spol.s.r.o.
  
Czech Republic
WABCO B.V.
  
Netherlands
WABCO (China) Co Ltd.
  
China, Peoples Republic of
WABCO Compressor Manufacturing Co, a partnership.
  
Delaware
WABCO Development GmbH, Hanover
  
Germany
WABCO Espana S.L.U
  
Spain
WABCO Europe Holdings B.V.
  
Netherlands
WABCO Expats Inc.
  
Delaware
WABCO Fahrzeugsysteme GmbH, Hanover
  
Germany
WABCO France Logistics S.A.S.
  
France
WABCO France SAS
  
France
WABCO GmbH (Bonn)
  
Germany
WABCO GmbH (Hanover)
  
Germany
WABCO Group Inc.
  
Delaware
WABCO Group International Inc.
  
Delaware
WABCO IP Holdings LLC
  
Delaware
WABCO Hong Kong Ltd.
  
Hong Kong
WABCO Japan Inc.
  
Japan
WABCO Korea Ltd.
  
Korea
WABCO Logistics (Qingdao) Co., Ltd.
  
China, Peoples Republic of





WABCO Logistik GmbH
  
Germany
WABCO North America LLC
  
Delaware
WABCO Polska Spólka z ograniczona odpowiedzialnoscia
  
Poland
WABCO Radbremsen GmbH
  
Germany
WABCO Sandown B.V.
  
Netherlands
WABCO (Schweiz) GmbH / WABCO (Suisse) Sarl (French)
  
Switzerland
WABCO Services SAS
  
France
WABCO (Shanghai) Management Co., Ltd
  
China, Peoples Republic of
WABCO Holding GmbH
  
Germany
WABCO Systeme GmbH
  
Germany
WABCO Arac Kontrol Sistemleri Destek ve Pazarlama Limited Sirketi
 
Turkey
WABCO Testbahn GmbH
  
Germany
WABCO Middle-East and Africa FZCO
  
Dubai
WABCO-TVS (India)
  
India
Guang Dong WABCO Fuwa Vehicle Brakes CO., LTD.
  
China, Peoples Republic of
WABCO Foundation Brakes Private Limited
 
India
WABCOWURTH Workshop Services GmbH, a partnership
 
Germany
WABCO Centro de Distribuicao de Pecas Automotivas Ltda
 
Brazil







CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
We consent to the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statements (Forms S-8 No. 333-159851, 333-144906 & 333-148972) of WABCO Holdings Inc. of our reports dated February 17, 2012, with respect to the consolidated financial statements and schedule of WABCO Holding Inc. and subsidiaries and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting of WABCO Holdings Inc. and subsidiaries, included in this Annual Report (Form 10-K) for the year ended December 31, 2011.
Ernst & Young Bedrijfsrevisoren BCVBA/Réviseurs d'Entreprises SCCRL
Represented by:
/s/ Harry Everaerts, Partner

Brussels, Belgium
February 17, 2012






POWER OF ATTORNEY


KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that I, …………., a member of the board of Directors of WABCO Holdings Inc., a Delaware corporation, (the “Company”) hereby constitute and appoint the Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, the Treasurer, the Controller, the Secretary, the Assistant Secretary and the Chief Human Resources Officer, and each of them, my true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution for me and in my name, place and stead, to sign the Form 10-K Annual Report for the Company's fiscal year ended December 31, 2011, and all amendments thereto, and to file the same with the Securities and Exchange Commission and the appropriate securities exchange, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, or their substitutes, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite or necessary to be done in and about the premises, as fully to all intents and purposes as I might or could do in person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, or their substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof. This Power of Attorney shall be effective until such time as I deliver a written revocation thereof to the above-named attorneys-in-fact and agents.




Date:         


        
Name





Exhibit 31.1
CERTIFICATIONS
I, Jacques Esculier, certify that:
1.
I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of WABCO Holdings Inc.;
2.
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3.
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4.
The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
(a)
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
(b)
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
(c)
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
(d)
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5.
The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
(a)
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
(b)
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.
Date: February 17, 2012
/s/ Jacques Esculier
Jacques Esculier
Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board




Exhibit 31.2
CERTIFICATIONS
I, Ulrich Michel, certify that:
1.
I have reviewed this annual report on Form 10-K of WABCO Holdings Inc.;
2.
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;
3.
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;
4.
The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:
(a)
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;
(b)
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;
(c)
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and
(d)
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and
5.
The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):
(a)
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and
(b)
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting.
Date: February 17, 2012
/s/ Ulrich Michel
Ulrich Michel
Chief Financial Officer




Exhibit 32.1
WABCO HOLDINGS INC.
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO 18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350 AS ADOPTED
PURSUANT TO SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002
In connection with the Annual Report of WABCO Holdings Inc. (the “Company”) on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011 as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, Jacques Esculier, the Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board of the Company, hereby certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350, as adopted pursuant to §906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that
(i)
the Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and
(ii)
the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company as of and for the periods covered in the Report.  
/s/ Jacques Esculier
Jacques Esculier
Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board
Dated: February 17, 2012




Exhibit 32.2
WABCO HOLDINGS INC.
CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO 18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350 AS ADOPTED
PURSUANT TO SECTION 906 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002
In connection with the Annual Report of WABCO Holdings Inc. (the “Company”) on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2011 as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the “Report”), I, Ulrich Michel, the Chief Financial Officer of the Company, hereby certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. §1350, as adopted pursuant to §906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that:
(i)
the Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and
(ii)
the information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company as of and for the periods covered in the Report.  
/s/ Ulrich Michel
Ulrich Michel
Chief Financial Officer
Dated: February 17, 2012